Äîêóìåíò âçÿò èç êýøà ïîèñêîâîé ìàøèíû. Àäðåñ îðèãèíàëüíîãî äîêóìåíòà : http://www.naic.edu/~phil/td/hardware/new/galil_usrman14x5_16.pdf
Äàòà èçìåíåíèÿ: Wed Nov 16 02:13:12 2011
Äàòà èíäåêñèðîâàíèÿ: Tue Feb 5 10:28:21 2013
Êîäèðîâêà:

Ïîèñêîâûå ñëîâà: http astrokuban.info astrokuban
USER MANUAL

DMC-14x5/6
Manual Rev. 2.7

By Galil Motion Control, Inc.

Galil Motion Control, Inc. 270 Technology Way Rocklin, California 95765 Phone: (916) 626-0101 Fax: (916) 626-0102 Internet Address: support@galilmc.com URL: www.galilmc.com Rev 8/2011


Using This Manual
This user manual provides information for proper operation of the DMC-1415, DMC-1416 and DMC1425 controllers. A separate supplemental manual, the Command Reference, contains a description of the commands available for use with these controllers. Your DMC-14XX motion controller has been designed to work with both servo and stepper type motors. Installation and system setup will vary depending upon whether the controller will be used with stepper motors or servo motors. To make finding the appropriate instructions faster and easier, icons will be next to any information that applies exclusively to one type of system. Otherwise, assume that the instructions apply to all types of systems. The icon legend is shown below.

Attention: Pertains to servo motor use. Attention: Pertains to stepper motor use.

WARNING: Machinery in motion can be dangerous! It is the responsibility of the user to design effective error handling and safety protection as part of the machine. Galil shall not be liable or responsible for any incidental or consequential damages.


Contents
Using This Manual .................................................................................................................... ii

Chapter 1 Overview

1

Introduction ............................................................................................................................... 1 Overview of Motor Types.......................................................................................................... 2 Standard Servo Motors with +/- 10 Volt Command Signal......................................... 2 Brushless Servo Motor with Sinusoidal Commutation................................................ 2 Stepper Motor with Step and Direction Signals .......................................................... 2 DMC-14XX Functional Elements ............................................................................................. 3 Microcomputer Section ............................................................................................... 3 Motor Interface ............................................................................................................ 3 Communication ........................................................................................................... 3 General I/O .................................................................................................................. 4 System Elements ......................................................................................................... 4 Motor ...........................................................................................................................4 Amplifier (Driver) ....................................................................................................... 4 Encoder........................................................................................................................ 5 Watch Dog Timer ........................................................................................................ 5

Chapter 2 Getting Started

7

The DMC-141X Motion Controller ........................................................................................... 7 Elements You Need ................................................................................................................... 8 Installing the DMC-14XX Controller ........................................................................................ 9 Step 1. Determine Overall Motor Configuration ........................................................ 9 Step 2. Configuring Jumpers on the DMC-14XX ..................................................... 10 Step 3. Connecting DC power and the Serial Cable to the DMC-14XX ................... 11 Step 4. Installing the Communications Software....................................................... 12 Step 5. Establishing Communication between the DMC-14XX and the host PC ..... 12 Step 6. Set-up axis for sinusoidal commutation (DMC-1415 only) ......................... 18 Step 7. Make connections to amplifier and encoder .................................................. 18 Step 8a. Connect Standard Servo Motor................................................................... 20 Step 8b. Connect brushless motor for sinusoidal commutation (DMC- 1415 only) . 23 Step 8c. Connect Step Motors ................................................................................... 26 Step 8d. Connect brush or brushless servo motor to DMC-1416 ............................. 26 Step 9. Tune the Servo System .................................................................................. 27 Design Examples ..................................................................................................................... 28 Example 1 - System Set-up ....................................................................................... 28 Example 2 - Profiled Move ....................................................................................... 28 Example 3 - Position Interrogation ............................................................................ 28 Example 4 - Absolute Position .................................................................................. 29 Example 5 - Velocity Control (Jogging) ................................................................... 29 Example 6 - Operation Under Torque Limit ............................................................. 29 Example 7 - Interrogation .......................................................................................... 30 Example 8 - Operation in the Buffer Mode ............................................................... 30 Example 9 - Motion Programs................................................................................... 30

DMC-14x5/6

Contents i


Example Example Example Example

10 - Motion Programs with Loops.............................................................. 11- Motion Programs with Trippoints ........................................................ 12 - Control Variables ................................................................................ 13 - Control Variables and Offset ..............................................................

30 31 31 32

Chapter 3 Connecting Hardware

33
33 33 33 34 34 35 35 36 36 36

Overview ................................................................................................................................. Using Inputs ............................................................................................................................. Limit Switch Input..................................................................................................... Home Switch Input .................................................................................................... Abort Input ................................................................................................................ Uncommitted Digital Inputs ...................................................................................... Amplifier Interface .................................................................................................................. TTL Inputs ............................................................................................................................... Analog Inputs .......................................................................................................................... TTL Outputs ............................................................................................................................

Chapter 4 Communication

39
39 39 39 39 40 40 40 42 43 43 44 44 45 46 47 47 47 48

Introduction ............................................................................................................................. RS232 Port ............................................................................................................................... RS232 - Port 1 DATATERM ................................................................................ RS-232 Configuration ............................................................................................... Ethernet Configuration ............................................................................................................ Communication Protocols ......................................................................................... Addressing ................................................................................................................. Communicating with Multiple Devices ..................................................................... Multicasting ............................................................................................................... Using Third Party Software ....................................................................................... Data Record ............................................................................................................................. Data Record Map....................................................................................................... Explanation of Status Information and Axis Switch Information.............................. Notes Regarding Velocity and Torque Information .................................................. QZ Command ............................................................................................................ Controller Response to Commands ......................................................................................... Unsolicited Messages Generated by Controller ....................................................................... Galil Software Tools and Libraries ..........................................................................................

Chapter 5 Command Basics

49
49 49 50 50 51 52 53 53 53 53 54 54 54

Introduction ............................................................................................................................. Command Syntax - ASCII ....................................................................................................... Coordinated Motion with more than 1 axis ............................................................... Command Syntax - Binary ...................................................................................................... Binary Command Format .......................................................................................... Binary Command Table ............................................................................................ Controller Response to DATA ................................................................................................ Interrogating the Controller ..................................................................................................... Interrogation Commands ........................................................................................... Summary of Interrogation Commands ...................................................................... Interrogating Current Commanded Values. ............................................................... Operands.................................................................................................................... Command Summary ..................................................................................................

Chapter 6 Programming Motion

55

ii i Contents

DMC-14x5/6


Overview ................................................................................................................................. 55 Independent Axis Positioning .................................................................................................. 56 Command Summary - Independent Axis .................................................................. 57 Independent Jogging ................................................................................................................ 59 Command Summary - Jogging .................................................................................. 59 Operand Summary - Independent Axis ..................................................................... 59 Linear Interpolation Mode .......................................................................................................60 Specifying Linear Segments ...................................................................................... 60 Command Summary - Linear Interpolation ............................................................... 62 Operand Summary - Linear Interpolation.................................................................. 62 Example - Linear Move ............................................................................................. 63 Example - Multiple Moves ........................................................................................ 65 Vector Mode: Linear and Circular Interpolation Motion ......................................................... 65 Specifying Vector Segments ..................................................................................... 65 Additional commands ................................................................................................ 66 Command Summary - Coordinated Motion Sequence .............................................. 67 Operand Summary - Coordinated Motion Sequence ................................................. 67 Electronic Gearing ................................................................................................................... 68 Command Summary - Electronic Gearing ................................................................ 69 Electronic Cam ........................................................................................................................ 70 Contour Mode .......................................................................................................................... 75 Specifying Contour Segments ................................................................................... 75 Additional Commands ............................................................................................... 76 Command Summary - Contour Mode ....................................................................... 76 Operand Summary - Contour Mode .......................................................................... 77 Stepper Motor Operation .........................................................................................................80 Specifying Stepper Motor Operation ......................................................................... 81 Using an Encoder with Stepper Motors ..................................................................... 82 Command Summary - Stepper Motor Operation....................................................... 82 Operand Summary - Stepper Motor Operation.......................................................... 82 Aux Encoder/ Dual Loop (DMC-1415 and DMC-1416 only) ................................................. 83 Backlash Compensation ............................................................................................ 83 Motion Smoothing ................................................................................................................... 85 Using the IT and VT Commands ............................................................................... 85 Using the KS Command (Step Motor Smoothing) .................................................... 86 Homing .................................................................................................................................... 87 High Speed Position Capture ................................................................................................... 90

Chapter 7 Application Programming

91

Overview ................................................................................................................................. 91 Using the DMC-14XX Editor to Enter Programs .................................................................... 91 Edit Mode Commands ............................................................................................... 92 Program Format ....................................................................................................................... 92 Using Labels in Programs ......................................................................................... 92 Special Labels............................................................................................................ 93 Commenting Programs .............................................................................................. 94 Executing Programs - Multitasking ......................................................................................... 95 Debugging Programs ............................................................................................................... 96 Program Flow Commands ....................................................................................................... 98 Event Triggers & Trippoints...................................................................................... 98 Event Trigger Examples: ......................................................................................... 100 Conditional Jumps ................................................................................................... 102 Using If, Else, and Endif Commands ...................................................................... 104 Subroutines .............................................................................................................. 106 Stack Manipulation.................................................................................................. 106

DMC-14x5/6

Contents i iii


Auto-Start Routine .................................................................................................. 106 Automatic Subroutines for Monitoring Conditions ................................................. 107 Mathematical and Functional Expressions ............................................................................ 110 Mathematical Operators .......................................................................................... 110 Bit-Wise Operators .................................................................................................. 111 Functions ................................................................................................................. 112 Variables ................................................................................................................................ 112 Programmable Variables ......................................................................................... 113 Operands ................................................................................................................................ 114 Special Operands (Keywords) ................................................................................. 114 Arrays .................................................................................................................................... 115 Defining Arrays ....................................................................................................... 115 Assignment of Array Entries ................................................................................... 115 Automatic Data Capture into Arrays ....................................................................... 116 Deallocating Array Space ........................................................................................ 118 Input of Data (Numeric and String) ....................................................................................... 118 Input of Data............................................................................................................ 118 Output of Data (Numeric and String) .................................................................................... 119 Sending Messages ................................................................................................... 119 Displaying Variables and Arrays ............................................................................. 120 Interrogation Commands ......................................................................................... 120 Formatting Variables and Array Elements .............................................................. 122 Converting to User Units ......................................................................................... 123 Programmable Hardware I/O ................................................................................................. 123 Digital Outputs ........................................................................................................ 123 Digital Inputs ........................................................................................................... 124 Input Interrupt Function .......................................................................................... 125 Example Applications ............................................................................................................126 Wire Cutter .............................................................................................................. 126 X-Y Table Controller .............................................................................................. 127

Chapter 8 Hardware & Software Protection

131
131 131 131 132 132 132 133 133 133

Introduction ........................................................................................................................... Hardware Protection .............................................................................................................. Output Protection Lines ........................................................................................... Input Protection Lines ............................................................................................. Software Protection ............................................................................................................... Programmable Position Limits ................................................................................ Off-On-Error ........................................................................................................... Automatic Error Routine ......................................................................................... Limit Switch Routine ..............................................................................................

Chapter 9 Troubleshooting

135
135 135 136 136 136

Overview ............................................................................................................................... Installation ............................................................................................................................. Communication...................................................................................................................... Stability .................................................................................................................................. Operation ...............................................................................................................................

Chapter 10 Theory of Operation

137
137 139 140 141

Overview ............................................................................................................................... Operation of Closed-Loop Systems ....................................................................................... System Modeling ................................................................................................................... Motor-Amplifier ......................................................................................................

iv i Contents

DMC-14x5/6


Encoder.................................................................................................................... DAC ........................................................................................................................ Digital Filter ............................................................................................................ ZOH......................................................................................................................... System Analysis..................................................................................................................... System Design and Compensation......................................................................................... The Analytical Method ............................................................................................

143 144 144 144 145 147 147

Appendices

151

Electrical Specifications ........................................................................................................ 151 Servo Control .......................................................................................................... 151 Stepper Control........................................................................................................ 151 Input/Output ............................................................................................................ 151 Power Requirements ................................................................................................ 151 Performance Specifications ................................................................................................... 152 Fast Update Rate Mode ......................................................................................................... 152 Connectors for DMC-14XX .................................................................................................. 153 J3 DMC-1415 General I/O; 37- PIN D-type ........................................................... 153 J3 DMC-1425 General I/O; 37- PIN D-type ........................................................... 153 J3 DMC-1416 General I/O; 37- PIN D-type ........................................................... 154 J4 DMC-1416 Encoders; 15-Pin D-type.................................................................. 155 J5 DMC-1416 Power; 5-Pin MOLEX; Brushless Config. (Standard Servo)........... 155 J1 RS232 Main port: DB-9 Pin Male: ..................................................................... 155 Pin-Out Description ............................................................................................................... 156 ICM-1460 Interconnect Module ............................................................................................ 157 Opto-Isolation Option for ICM-1460 (rev F and above) ....................................................... 159 64 Extended I/O of the DMC-1415/1416/1425 Controller .................................................... 160 Configuring the I/O of the DMC-1415/1416/1425 with DB-14064 ........................ 160 Connector Description: ............................................................................................ 162 IOM-1964 Opto-Isolation Module for Extended I/O Controllers .......................................... 164 Description: ............................................................................................................. 164 Overview ................................................................................................................. 165 Configuring Hardware Banks .................................................................................. 166 Digital Inputs ........................................................................................................... 166 High Power Digital Outputs .................................................................................... 168 Standard Digital Outputs ......................................................................................... 169 Electrical Specifications .......................................................................................... 170 Relevant DMC Commands...................................................................................... 171 J5 80-pin Connector Pin out .................................................................................... 171 Screw Terminal Listing ........................................................................................... 173 CB-50-80 Adapter Board ....................................................................................................... 176 Connectors:.............................................................................................................. 176 CB-50-80 Drawing: ................................................................................................. 178 Coordinated Motion - Mathematical Analysis ....................................................................... 179 List of Other Publications ......................................................................................................183 Training Seminars .................................................................................................................. 183 Contacting Us ........................................................................................................................ 184 WARRANTY ........................................................................................................................185

Index

186

DMC-14x5/6

Contents i v


THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK INTENTIONALLY

vi i Contents

DMC-14x5/6


Chapter 1 Overview

Introduction
The DMC-1400 series of motion controllers were developed specifically for one or two axis applications, allowing it to be smaller in size (1/2 size card) and lower in cost than the Optima series multi-axis controllers. This manual covers three Ethernet based stand-alone controllers in the DMC1400 Econo series. The DMC-1415 is a state-of-the-art single axis motion controller that communicates via the Ethernet. The DMC-1425 is the identical controller configured for basic two axis applications. The DMC-1416 is a single axis Ethernet controller integrated with an internal brush or brushless power amplifier. Performance capability of these controllers includes: 12 MHz encoder input frequency, 16-bit motor command output DAC, +/-2 billion counts total travel per move, 250 sec minimum sample rate and non-volatile memory for program and parameter storage. Designed for maximum flexibility, the DMC-14XX can be interfaced to a variety of motors and drives including step motors, brush and brushless servo motors and hydraulics. The DMC-1415 can also be configured to provide sinusoidal commutation for brushless motors. The controller accepts feedback from a quadrature linear or rotary encoder with input frequencies up to 12 million quadrature counts per second. An additional encoder input is available on the DMC-1415 and DMC-1416 for gearing or cam applications, hand wheel inputs, or dual-loop operation. Modes of motion include jogging, point-to-point positioning, electronic cam, electronic gearing and contouring. Several motion parameters can be specified including acceleration and deceleration rates and slew speed. The DMC-14XX also provides motion smoothing to eliminate jerk. For synchronization with outside events, the DMC-14XX provides uncommitted I/O. The DMC-1415 and DMC-1416 provide 7 digital inputs, 3 digital outputs and 2 analog inputs. The DMC-1425 provides up to 3 digital inputs, 3 digital outputs and 2 analog inputs. Committed digital inputs are provided for forward and reverse limits, abort, home, and definable input interrupts. Event triggers can automatically check for elapsed time, distance and motion complete. The DMC-14XX is easy to program. Instructions are represented by two letter commands such as BG for Begin and SP for Speed. Conditional instructions, Jump statements and arithmetic functions are included for writing self-contained applications programs. An internal editor allows programs to be quickly entered and edited, and support software such as the WSDK allows quick system set-up and tuning. Commands may also be sent in Binary to decrease processing time. To prevent system damage during machine operation, the DMC-14XX provides many error handling features. These include software and hardware limits, automatic shut-off on excessive error, abort input and user-definable error and limit routines. The DMC-1415 and DMC-1425 are designed for stand-alone applications and provide non-volatile storage for programs, variables and array elements. The DMC-1416 provides an internal brush or brushless power amplifier for a standard DC servo motor.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 1 Overview i 1


Overview of Motor Types
The DMC-14XX can provide the following types of motor control: 1. 2. 3. 4. Standard servo motors with +/- 10 volt command signals Brushless servo motors with sinusoidal commutation Step motors with step and direction signals Other actuators such as hydraulics - For more information, contact Galil.

The user can configure each axis for any combination of motor types, providing maximum flexibility.

Standard Servo Motors with +/- 10 Volt Command Signal
The DMC-14XX achieves superior precision through use of a 16-bit motor command output DAC and a sophisticated PID filter that features velocity and acceleration feedforward, an extra notch filter and integration limits. The controller is configured by the factory for standard servo motor operation. In this configuration, the controller provides an analog signal (+/- 10Volt) to connect to a servo amplifier. This connection is described in Chapter 2. In the case of the DMC-1416, a brush or brushless servo amplifier is connected to the analog signal internally.

Brushless Servo Motor with Sinusoidal Commutation
The DMC-1415 can provide sinusoidal commutation for brushless motors (BLM). In this configuration, the controller generates two sinusoidal signals for connection with amplifiers specifically designed for this purpose. Note: The task of generating sinusoidal commutation may be accomplished in the brushless motor amplifier. If the amplifier generates the sinusoidal commutation signals, only a single command signal is required and the controller should be configured for a standard servo motor (described above). Sinusoidal commutation in the controller can be used with linear and rotary BLMs. However, the motor velocity should be limited such that a magnetic cycle lasts at least 6 milliseconds*. For faster motors, please contact the factory. The controller provides a one-time, automatic set-up procedure. The parameters determined by this procedure can then be saved in non-volatile memory to be used whenever the system is powered on. The DMC-1415 can control BLMs equipped with Hall sensors as well as without Hall sensors. If hall sensors are available, once the controller has been setup, the controller will estimate the commutation phase upon reset. This allows the motor to function immediately upon power up. The Hall effect sensors also provide a method for setting the precise commutation phase. Chapter 2 describes the proper connection and procedure for using sinusoidal commutation of brushless motors. * 6 Milliseconds per magnetic cycle assumes a servo update of 1 msec (default rate).

Stepper Motor with Step and Direction Signals
The DMC-14XX can control stepper motors. In this mode, the controller provides two signals to connect to the stepper motor: Step and Direction. For stepper motor operation, the controller does not require an encoder and operates the stepper motor in an open loop. Chapter 2 describes the proper connection and procedure for using stepper motors. NOTE: Hardware revisions A-D need factory reconfiguration in order to control steppers. Hardware revisions E or newer have jumpers for stepper configuration.

2 i Chapter 1 Overview

DMC-14x5/6


DMC-14XX Functional Elements
The DMC-14XX circuitry can be divided into the following functional groups as shown in Figure 1.1 and discussed below.
WATCHDOG TIMER

ISOLATED LIMITS AND HOME INPUTS ETHERNET 68331 MICROCOMPUTER WITH 1 Meg RAM 2 Meg FLASH EEPROM HIGH-SPEED MOTOR/ENCODER INTERFACE FOR X,Y,Z,W MAIN ENCODERS AUXILIARY ENCODERS +/- 10 VOLT OUTPUT FOR SERVO MOTORS PULSE/DIRECTION OUTPUT FOR STEP MOTORS

RS-232 /

I/O INTERFACE

HIGH SPEED ENCODER COMPARE OUTPUT

2 UNCOMMITTED ANALOG INPUTS

7 PROGRAMMABLE, INPUTS

3 PROGRAMMABLE OUTPUTS

HIGH-SPEED LATCH FOR EACH AXIS

Figure 1.1 - DMC-14XX Functional Elements

Microcomputer Section
The main processing unit of the DMC-14XX is a specialized 32-bit Motorola 68331 Series Microcomputer with 1 Meg RAM and 2 Meg Flash EEPROM. The RAM provides memory for variables, array elements and application programs. The flash EEPROM provides non-volatile storage of variables, programs, and arrays. It also contains the DMC-14XX firmware.

Motor Interface
Galil's 12 MH DAC). analog GL-1800 custom, sub-micron gate array performs quadrature decoding of each encoder at up to z. For standard servo operation, the controller generates a +/-10 Volt analog signal (16 Bit For sinusoidal commutation operation, the controller uses two DACs to generate two +/-10Volt signals. For stepper motor operation, the controller generates a step and direction signal.

Communication
The communication interface with the DMC-14XX consists of one RS-232 port (19.2 kbaud) and one 10base-T Ethernet port.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 1 Overview i 3


General I/O
The DMC-1415 and DMC-1416 provide interface circuitry for 7 TTL inputs and 3 TTL outputs. In addition, the controller provides two 12-bit analog inputs. The general inputs can also be used for triggering a high speed positional latch for each axis. NOTE: In order to accommodate 2 axes on the DMC-1425, many of the general I/O features become dedicated I/O for the second axis. The standard DMC-1425 will have 3 TTL inputs, 3 TTL outputs and 2 analog inputs.

System Elements
As shown in Fig. 1.2, the DMC-14XX is part of a motion control system which includes amplifiers, motors and encoders. These elements are described below.

Power Supply

Computer

DMC-141X Controller

Amplifier (Driver)

Encoder

Motor

Figure 1.2 - Elements of Servo systems

Motor
A motor converts current into torque which produces motion. Each axis of motion requires a motor sized properly to move the load at the required speed and acceleration. (Galil's "Motion Component Selector" software can help you with motor sizing). Contact Galil for more information. The motor may be a step or servo motor and can be brush-type or brushless, rotary or linear. For step motors, the controller is capable of controlling full-step, half-step, or microstep drives. An encoder is not required when step motors are used.

Amplifier (Driver)
For each axis, the power amplifier converts a +/-10 Volt signal from the controller into current to drive the motor. For stepper motors, the amplifier converts step and direction signals into current. The amplifier should be sized properly to meet the power requirements of the motor. For brushless motors, an amplifier that provides electronic commutation is required or the controller must be configured to provide sinusoidal commutation. The amplifiers may be either pulse-width-modulated (PWM) or linear. They may also be configured for operation with or without a tachometer. For current amplifiers, the amplifier gain should be set such that a 10 Volt command generates the maximum required current. For example, if the peak motor current is 10A, the amplifier gain should be 1 A/V. For velocity mode amplifiers, 10 Volts should run the motor at the maximum speed. For step motors, the amplifiers should accept step and direction signals.

4 i Chapter 1 Overview

DMC-14x5/6


For the DMC-1416, the power amplifier is internal to the unit. The controller may be purchased with either a brush or brushless PWM amplifier. The amplifier requires a single external DC power supply from 20 to 60 Volts. The amplifier provides 6 amps continuous at 12 amps peak.

Encoder
An encoder translates motion into electrical pulses which are fed back into the controller. The DMC14XX accepts feedback from either a rotary or linear encoder. Typical encoders provide two channels in quadrature, known as CHA and CHB. This type of encoder is known as a quadrature encoder. Quadrature encoders may be either single-ended (CHA and CHB) or differential (CHA,CHA-, CHB,CHB-). The DMC-14XX decodes either type into quadrature states or four times the number of cycles. Encoders may also have a third channel (or index) for synchronization. For stepper motors, the DMC-14XX can also interface to encoders with pulse and direction signals. There is no limit on encoder line density; however, the input frequency to the controller must not exceed 3,000,000 full encoder cycles/second (12,000,000 quadrature counts/sec). For example, if the encoder line density is 10000 cycles per inch, the maximum speed is 300 inches/second. If higher encoder frequency is required, please consult the factory. The standard voltage level is TTL (zero to five volts), however, voltage levels up to 12 Volts are acceptable. (If using differential signals, 12 Volts can be input directly to the DMC-14XX. Singleended 12 Volt signals require a bias voltage input to the complementary inputs.) The DMC-14XX can accept analog feedback instead of an encoder for any axis. For more information see description of analog feedback in Chapter 2 under the section titled "Test the encoder operation". To interface with other types of position sensors such as resolvers or absolute encoders, Galil can customize the controller and command set. Please contact Galil to talk to one of our applications engineers about your particular system requirements.

Watch Dog Timer
The DMC-14XX provides an internal watch dog timer which checks for proper microprocessor operation. The timer toggles the Amplifier Enable Output (AEN) which can be used to switch the amplifiers off in the event of a serious DMC-14XX failure. The AEN output is normally high. During power-up and if the microprocessor ceases to function properly, the AEN output will go low. The error light for each axis will also turn on at this stage. A reset is required to restore the DMC-14XX to normal operation. Consult the factory for a Return Materials Authorization (RMA) Number if your DMC-14XX is damaged.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 1 Overview i 5


THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK INTENTIONALLY

6 i Chapter 1 Overview

DMC-14x5/6


Chapter 2 Getting Started

The DMC-141X Motion Controller

Figure 2.1 ­ Outline of the DMC-1415/DMC-1425

2

1

6

JP1 7 JP 2 J1 J4 3

J2

5 J3 4

J5

Figure 2.2 ­ Outline of the DMC-1416

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 2 Getting Started i 7


1 2 3 4

DMC-141X Flash EEPROM Motorola 68331 microprocessor GL-1800 custom gate array Reset switch

J2 J3 J4 J5

10Base-T Ethernet connection 37 Pin-D connection for controller signal breakout 15 Pin-D connection for controller main encoder breakout (DMC-1416) 6 Pin power connector for +5V, +12V and ­12V input (DMC-1415/DMC-1425) 5 Pin connector for 20 ­ 60V DC supply and motor connections (DMC-1416)

5

Error LED's for active Ethernet connection, transmit/receive on Ethernet, error output and power. Controller RAM Fuse for DC-to-DC converter. RS232 Serial connection

JP1

Master reset , upgrade and baud rate selection jumpers, Y step Motor off as default jumper. Stepper motor jumper (DMC-1415/DMC-1425) Jumper for selecting analog motor command or step and direction pin-out configuration.

6 7 J1

JP2 JP3

Elements You Need
Before you start, you must get all the necessary system elements. These include: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. DMC-1415, DMC-1425 or DMC-1416 Controller, and 37-pin cable (order Cable -37). Servo motor(s) with Encoder or stepper motor. Appropriate motor drive - servo amp (Power Amplifier or AMP-1460) or stepper drive. Power Supply for Amplifier +5V, ±12V supply for DMC-1415 or DMC-1425 card level 20V to 60V DC supply for DMC-1416 Communication CD from Galil WSDK Servo Design Software (not necessary, but strongly recommended) Interface Module ICM-1460 with screw-type terminals or integrated Interface Module/Amplifier, AMP-1460. (Note: An interconnect module is not necessary, but strongly recommended.)

The motors may be servo (brush or brushless type) or steppers. The driver (amplifier) should be suitable for the motor and may be linear or pulse-width-modulated and it may have current feedback or voltage feedback. For servo motors, the drivers should accept an analog signal in the +/-10 Volt range as a command. The amplifier gain should be set so that a +10V command will generate the maximum required current. For example, if the motor peak current is 10A, the amplifier gain should be 1 A/V. For velocity mode amplifiers, a command signal of 10 Volts should run the motor at the maximum required speed. For step motors, the driver should accept step and direction signals. For start-up of a step motor system refer to Step 8c "Connecting Step Motors".

8 i Chapter 2 Getting Started

DMC-14x5/6


For the DMC-1416, the internal amplifier is a 20V to 60V PWM amplifier in either a brush or brushless configuration, so only a brush or brushless DC servo motor may be used. The WSDK software is highly recommended for first time users of the DMC-14XX. It provides stepby-step instructions for system connection, tuning and analysis.

Installing the DMC-14XX Controller
Installation of a complete, operational DMC-14XX system consists of 9 steps. Step 1. Determine overall motor configuration. Step 2. Configuring jumpers on the DMC-14XX. Step 3. Connect the DC power supply and serial cable to the DMC-14XX. Step 4. Install the communications software. Step 5. Establish communications between the DMC-14XX and the host PC. Step 6. Set-up axis for sinusoidal commutation (DMC-1415 only). Step 7. Make connections to amplifier and encoder. Step 8a. Connect standard servo motor. Step 8b. Connect brushless motor for sinusoidal commutation. (DMC-1415 only) Step 8c. Connect step motor. Step 8d. Connect brush or brushless servo motor to DMC-1416 Step 9. Tune servo system.

Step 1. Determine Overall Motor Configuration
Before setting up the motion control system, the user must determine the desired motor configuration. The DMC-141X can control standard brush or brushless servo motors, sinusoidally commutated brushless motors or stepper motors. For control of other types of actuators, such as hydraulics, please contact Galil. The following configuration information is necessary to determine the proper motor configuration: Standard Servo Motor Operation: The DMC-141X has been setup by the factory for standard servo motor operation providing an analog command signal of +/- 10 volt. The position of the jumpers at JP3 determines the type of output the controllers will provide, analog motor command or PWM output. The installation of these jumpers is discussed in the section "Configuring Jumpers on the DMC-14XX". Figure 2.3 shows how the jumpers are configured for the standard output mode. The DMC-14XX controller will output the analog command signal to either brush or brushless servo amplifiers. Please note that if the brushless amplifier provides the sinusoidal commutation, the standard servo motor operation from the controller will be used. If the commutation is to be performed by the controller, please see below. The DMC-1416 provides an internal PWM amplifier for connection directly to a brush or brushless motor. Either the brush or brushless amplifier must be specified at the time of purchase. Sinusoidal Commutation: Please consult the factory before operating with sinusoidal commutation. Sinusoidal commutation is configured through a single software command, BA. This setting causes the controller to reconfigure the control axis to output two commutated phases. The DMC-1415 requires two DAC outputs for a single axis of commutation. Therefore, sinusoidal commutation is not

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 2 Getting Started i 9


available on the DMC-1425. In standard servo operation, the DMC-1415 has one DAC for the single axis. Issuing the BA command will enable the second DAC for commutation. Further instruction for sinusoidal commutation connections are discussed in Step 6. Stepper Motor Operation: To configure the DMC-141X for stepper motor operation, the controller requires that the command, MT, be given and jumpers placed to designate stepper motor. The installation of the stepper motor jumper is discussed in the following section entitled "Configuring Jumpers on the DMC-14XX". Further instructions for stepper motor connections are discussed in Step 8c.

Step 2. Configuring Jumpers on the DMC-14XX
Master Reset and Upgrade Jumper JP1 contains two jumpers, MR and UP. The MR jumper is the Master Reset jumper. When MR is connected, the controller will perform a master reset upon PC power up or upon the reset input going low. Whenever the controller has a master reset, all programs, arrays, variables, and motion control parameters stored in EEPROM will be ERASED. The UP jumper enables the user to unconditionally update the controller's firmware. This jumper is not necessary for firmware updates when the controller is operating normally, but may be necessary in cases of corrupted EEPROM. EEPROM corruption should never occur, however, it is possible if there is a power fault during a firmware update. If EEPROM corruption occurs, your controller may not operate properly. In this case, install the UP Jumper and use the update firmware function on the Galil Terminal to re-load the system firmware. Stepper Motor Jumpers - Hardware Rev A-D If the DMC-14XX will be driving a stepper motor, special stepper mode jumpers must be connected. Location JP2 on the DMC-14XX contains the jumper SMX. If stepper motors are being used, this jumper must be installed. In addition to the SMX jumper, the controller output must be configured for stepper output by the placement of jumpers at location JP3. This jumper location controls whether the controller will output the analog motor command signal (MC), or the step and direction signals (SD). Figure 2.3 shows how these jumpers should be configured for stepper mode. Please note, the standard DMC-1425 only provides access to one axis when in stepper mode. For both axes as steppers order as DMC-1425-STEPPER. Note: On the ICM-1460 the PULSE signal is output to pin 4 (ACMD) and the direction signal is output to pin 38 (ACMD2).

Stepper Motor Jumper Selection - Rev E or newer The newest version of the DMC-1425 the controller is configurable for stepper or servo through jumpers instead of needing rework done by the factory. The configuration is as followsJP2 SMX X Servo , Y Servo X Servo, Y Stepper X Stepper, Y Stepper X X X X X Top Row Both JP2 SMY JP1 Y Step JP3 SD JP3 MC Both Bottom Row

Note1: When the Y axis is set for stepper mode the pulse output for the Y axis is on the same pin as the error output meaning that the red LED will be on. To permanently disable the red LED contact Galil. Note2: When the controller is configured for X servo and Y stepper, the amp enable signal for the X axis is no longer available as it is used for Y sign.

10 i Chapter 2 Getting Started

DMC-14x5/6


JP 3 SD MC SD MC

JP 3

S e ttin g f o r a n a l o g m o to r c o m m a n d

S e tti n g f o r s te p /d ire c ti o n o u tp u t

Figure 2.3 - Jumper settings for motor command output

Setting the Baud Rate on the DMC-14XX The jumpers labeled "96" and "12" at JP1 allows the user to select the serial communication baud rate. The baud rate can be set using the following table: SWITCH SETTINGS 96
OFF ON OFF

BAUD RATE -19200 9600 1200

12
OFF OFF ON

The default baud rate for the controller is 19.2K. Selecting MO as default on the DMC-14XX The default condition for the motor on the DMC-14XX is in the servo on (SH) state. This will enable the amplifiers upon power up of the controller. This state can be changed to the motor off (MO) default by placing a jumper at JP2 across the MO terminals. This will power up the controller with the amplifiers disabled and the motor command off. The SH command must then actively be given in order for the servos or steppers to operate.

Step 3. Connecting DC power and the Serial Cable to the DMC-14XX
1. 2. Insert 37-pin cable to J3. If using serial communications, use the 9-pin RS232 ribbon cable to connect the SERIAL port of the DMC-14XX to your computer or terminal communications port. The DMC-14XX serial port is configured as DATASET. Your computer or terminal must be configured as a DATATERM for full duplex, no parity, 8 bits data, one start bit and one stop bit. Your computer needs to be configured as a "dumb" terminal which sends ASCII characters as they are typed to the DMC-14XX. Connections to the controller for Ethernet communication are covered in Step 5. 3. For the DMC-1415 and DMC-1425, apply ±12V, +5V power to the J5 connector. For the DMC-1416, apply a single, external DC supply from 20 to 60 volts to the 5-pin box connector at the locations V PWR+ and GND. This supply provides power for both the motion controller and the internal PWM amplifier. Warning: Damage to the DMC-1416 will occur if a supply larger than 60V is connected to the controller.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 2 Getting Started i 11


4.

Applying power will turn on the green LED power indicator.

Step 4. Installing the Communications Software
After applying power to the computer, you should install the Galil software that enables communication between the controller and PC. The CD-ROM used for the following installations is Version 11/01. Using DOS: Using the Galil Software CD-ROM, go to the directory, July2000 CD/DMCDOS/DISK1. Type INSTALL at the DOS prompt and follow the directions. Using Windows 3.x (16 bit versions): Explore the Galil Software CD ROM and go to the directory, July2000 CD/DMCWIN. Run DMCWIN16 and follow the directions. The Windows Servo Design Kit (WSDK16), which is useful for tuning servos and viewing useful controller information, can be downloaded off the CD as well. However, WSDK16 is a purchase only software package and is password protected on the CD. Contact Galil for purchase information. Using Windows 95 or 98 First Edition: The HTML page that opens automatically from the CD-ROM does not contain the necessary software for Windows 95 or Windows 98 First Edition. Instead, Explore the CD and go to the July2000 CD folder. To install the basic communications software click on DMCTERM and then run the application, DMCTERM. Another terminal software is called DMCWIN32 and is located under July2000 CD/DMCWIN. The Windows Servo Design Kit (WSDK32), which is useful for tuning servos and viewing useful controller information, can be downloaded off the CD as well. However, WSDK32 is a purchase only software package and is password protected on the CD. Contact Galil for purchase information. Using Windows 98 Second Edition (SE), NT 4, ME, 2000 or XP: The Galil Software CD-ROM will open an HTML page automatically as soon a Instead, Explore the CD and go to the July2000 CD folder. To install the basic communications software click on DMCTERM and then run the application, DMCTERM. The other basic terminal software is called DMCWIN32 and is located under July2000 CD/DMCWIN. The Windows Servo Design Kit (WSDK32), which is useful for tuning servos and viewing useful controller information, can be downloaded off the CD as well. However, WSDK32 is a purchase only software package and is password protected on the CD. Contact Galil for purchase information.

Step 5. Establishing Communication between the DMC-14XX and the host PC
Communicating through the RS-232 Serial Communications Port Connect the DMC-14XX serial port to your computer via the Galil CABLE-9PIN-D (RS-232 Cable).

Using Galil Software for DOS
To communicate with the DMC-14XX, type TALK2DMC at the prompt. Register the controller as a DMC-1412 and assign the proper baud rate and comm port. Once you have established communication, the terminal display should show a colon, :. If you do not receive a colon, press the carriage return. If a colon prompt is not returned, there is most likely an incorrect setting of the serial communications port. The user must ensure that the correct communication port and baud rate are specified when attempting to communicate with the controller. Please note that the serial port on the controller must be set for handshake mode for proper communication with Galil software. The user must also insure that the proper serial cable is being used, see appendix for pin-out of serial cable.

12 i Chapter 2 Getting Started

DMC-14x5/6


Using Galil Software for Windows 3.x, 95 and 98 SE
In order for the windows software to communicate with a Galil controller, the controller must be registered in the Windows Registry. To register a controller, you must specify the model of the controller, the communication parameters, and other information. The registry is accessed through the Galil software, such as WSDK and DTERM (DTERM is installed with DMCWIN and installed as the icon "Galil Terminal"). From WSDK, the registry is accessed under the FILE menu. From the DTERM program, the registry is accessed from the REGISTRY menu. The registry window is equipped with buttons to Add, Change, or Delete a controller. Pressing any of these buttons will bring up the Set Registry Information window. Use the Add button to add a new entry to the Registry. You will need to supply the Galil Controller type. The controller model number must be entered and if you are changing an existing controller, this field will already have an entry. Pressing the down arrow to the right of this field will reveal a menu of valid controller types. Note: If you are communicating to the DMC-14XX controller via the RS232 connection, the controller must be registered as a DMC-1412. The registry information will show a default Comm Port of 2 and a default Comm Speed of 9600 appears. This information should be changed as necessary to reflect the computers Comm Port and the baud rate set by the controller's baud rate jumpers. The registry entry also displays timeout and delay information. These are advanced parameters that should only be modified by advanced users (see software documentation for more information). Once you have set the appropriate Registry information for your controller, Select OK and close the registry window. You will now be able to communicate with the DMC-14XX. Once the entry has been selected, click on the OK button. If the software has successfully established communications with the controller, the registry entry will be displayed at the top of the screen. If you are not properly communicating with the controller, the program will pause for 3-15 seconds. The top of the screen will display the message "Status: not connected with Galil motion controller" and the following error will appear: "STOP - Unable to establish communication with the Galil controller. A time-out occurred while waiting for a response from the Galil controller." If this message appears, you must click OK. In this case, there is most likely an incorrect setting of the serial communications port. The user must ensure that the correct communication port and baud rate are specified when attempting to communicate with the controller. Please note that the serial port on the controller must be set for handshake mode for proper communication with Galil software. The user must also insure that the proper serial cable is being used, see appendix for pin-out of serial cable. Once you establish communications, click on the menu for terminal and you will receive a colon prompt. Communicating with the controller is described in later sections.

Using Galil Software for Windows 98 SE, NT 4, 2000, ME and XP
The registration process for the DMC-1415/1416/1425 controllers in these operating systems is very similar to the Windows 3.x/95/98 FE procedure. In DMC Terminal or WSDK, the Galil registry is accessed in the File menu by selecting "Register Controller". In DMCWIN, just click on the Registry menu button. The Galil Registry Dialog is shown below.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 2 Getting Started i 13


Select the button that says "New Controller" under the "Non-PnP Tools" and then select DMC-1415, DMC-1416 or DMC-1425 from the pull down menu. Make sure to select "Serial" as the "Connection Type". The next step is to select the Comm Port being used on the PC and the Comm Speed for data transfer. Hardware handshaking will be selected by default. Select `Next', and the controller will be entered into the registry. Connect to the controller by selecting the Terminal utility and choosing the controller from the registry list.

Note: Be sure to configure the Comm Speed jumpers for the same Comm Speed in the Galil Registry. No jumpers on the DMC-14XX indicates a Comm Speed of 19200 bits per second.

14 i Chapter 2 Getting Started

DMC-14x5/6


Using Non-Galil Communication Software
The DMC-14XX serial port is configured as DATASET. Your computer or terminal must be configured as a DATATERM for full duplex, no parity, 8 data bits, one start bit and one stop bit. Check to insure that the baud rate switches have been set to the desired baud rate as described above. Your computer needs to be configured as a "dumb" terminal which sends ASCII characters as they are they are typed to the DMC-14XX. An example of a "dumb" terminal would by HyperTerminal that is available under the Start menu/Programs/Accessories/Communications in the Windows operating systems. Sending Test Commands to the Terminal: After you connect your terminal, press or the key on your keyboard. In response to carriage return (CR), the controller responds with a colon, : Now type TPX (CR) This command directs the controller to return the current position of the X axis. The controller should respond with a number such as 0000000 Communicating through the Ethernet

Using DOS
The Galil software in DOS does not support communication over Ethernet.

Using Galil Software for Windows 3.x, 95, and 98 SE
The controller must be registered in the Windows registry for the host computer to communicate with it. The registry may be accessed via Galil software, such as WSDK or DTERM. From WSDK, the registry is accessed under the FILE menu. From DTERM it is accessed under the REGISTRY menu. Use the Add button to add a new entry in the registry. Choose DMC-1415 as the controller type. Enter the IP address obtained from your system administrator. Select the button corresponding to the UDP or TCP protocol in which you wish to communicate with the controller. If the IP address has not been already assigned to the controller, click on ASSIGN IP ADDRESS. Note: When communicating via the Ethernet, both the DMC-1425 and DMC-1416 will be registered as DMC-1415 controllers. ASSIGN IP ADDRESS will check the controllers that are linked to the network to see which ones do not have an IP address. The program will then ask you whether you would like to assign the IP address you entered to the controller with the specified serial number. Click on YES to assign it, NO to move to next controller, or CANCEL to not save the changes. If there are no controllers on the network that do not have an IP address assigned, the program will state this. When done registering, click on OK. If you do not wish to save the changes, click on CANCEL. Once the controller has been register, select the correct controller from the list and click on OK. If the software successfully established communications with the controller, the registry entry will be displayed at the top of the screen. If the above method is unsuccessful in assigning an IP address to a controller, the second option is connecting to the controller serially and using the IA command to assign the IP address. See the controller command reference for information on the IA command. Although the IP address can be assigned serially, the user must still register the controller as an Ethernet controller in order to

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 2 Getting Started i 15


communicate it over Ethernet. Follow the steps above for registering an Ethernet controller but do not click the ASSIGN IP ADDRESS button. Just click OK once the IP address has been entered in the text box, and the controller will be entered into the Galil registry. Connect to the controller through the Terminal utility.

Using Galil Software for Windows 98 SE, NT 4, 2000, ME and XP
The controller must be registered in the Windows registry for the host computer to communicate with it. The registry may be accessed via Galil software, such as WSDK, DMC Terminal or DTERM (DMCWIN). From WSDK and DMC Terminal, the registry is accessed under the FILE menu. From DTERM it is accessed under the REGISTRY menu. Use the "New Controller" button under "Non-PnP tools" to add a new entry in the registry. Choose DMC-1415, DMC-1416, or DMC-1425 as the controller type. Select "Ethernet" under the "Connection Type" and then `Next'. The following screen will allow the user to enter an IP address for the controller. This is a 4-byte number, each byte separated by periods. Also, select the Ethernet Protocol as either TCP or UDP. Galil recommends TCP because if information is lost during communication, it will be resent using this protocol. UDP is a more efficient protocol, but does not resend lost information. Enter the IP address obtained from your system administrator. Select the button corresponding to the UDP or TCP protocol in which you wish to communicate with the controller.

In the Ethernet Parameters window there are additional options under the Unsolicited Messages section to "Use current `CF' Setting", "Receive Through Second Handle", and "Receive Through Same Handle". The default selection is "Use current `CF' setting" which means that messages will be sent through the handle that's currently configured on the controller (i.e. no changes are made). If "Receive Through Second Handle" is selected, the controller will open a second TCP/UDP handle between the controller and computer over which unsolicited message are sent. A second thread listens for messages, which provides a faster response when compared to receiving messages through the same handle. If "Receive Through Same Handle" is selected, unsolicited message are sent back through the same handle that the terminal is using. Now the Galil software must poll to get these messages, which

16 i Chapter 2 Getting Started

DMC-14x5/6


slows the response time. For more information, contact Galil. Once all the Ethernet parameters are entered, select "Assign IP Address". The software will search for controllers that do not have IP addresses. Once the controller has been found and the IP address is assigned, select "Finish", and the controller will be entered in the Galil Registry. Connect to the controller through the Terminal. Another method of connecting to an Ethernet Controller is using the DMCNET utility in the Registry. Select "Find Ethernet Controller" under "Non PnP Tools" and the DMCNET window will appear and search for all controllers on the network. Once DMCNET is finished searching, the user can highlight one of the listed controllers and give it an IP address by selecting the "Assign" button. From there, the user can add the controller to the Galil registry by selecting the "Register" button. The "Connects..." button in DMCNET will provide a list of communication handles the controller maintains. Furthermore, the "Free Handles..." button frees all handles.

DMCNET Utility If the two methods above are unsuccessful in assigning an IP address to a controller, the third option is connecting to the controller serially and using the IA command to assign the IP address. See the controller command reference for information on the IA command. Although the IP address can be assigned serially, the user must still register the controller as an Ethernet controller in order to communicate it over Ethernet. Follow the steps above for registering an Ethernet controller but don't click the "Assign IP Address" button. Just click "Finish" once the IP address has been entered in the text box, and the controller will be entered into the Galil registry. Connect to the controller through the Terminal. When connecting to a controller via Ethernet, the user must be aware of the type of Ethernet cable being used, and the method of communication. To connect the controller directly to the PC, use a crossover or null-modem Ethernet cable. This type of cable allows for the crossing of signals between the PC and the controller. If instead the connection to the controller is through a network hub, a

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 2 Getting Started i 17


straight through cable must be used. Hubs perform the signal crossing function of a null-modem cable. If the wrong cable is used, communication with the controller will not be possible. Note: If an Ethernet controller is connected in a LAN, make sure the assigned IP address is allowed. Also, Galil strongly recommends the IP address selected cannot be accessed across the Gateway. The Gateway is an application that controls communication between an internal network and the outside world. Ask your network administrator for acceptable IP addresses. Sending Test Commands to the Terminal: After you connect your terminal, press or the key on your keyboard. In response to carriage return , the controller responds with a colon, : Now type TPX This command directs the controller to return the current position of the X axis. The controller should respond with a number such as 0000000

Step 6. Set-up axis for sinusoidal commutation (DMC-1415 only)
* This step is only required when the controller will be used to control a brushless motor with sinusoidal commutation. Please consult the factory before operating with sinusoidal commutation. The command BA is used to specify sinusoidal commutation mode for the DMC-1415. In this mode the controller will output two sinusoidal phases for the DACs. Once specified, follow the procedure outlined in Step 8b.

Step 7. Make connections to amplifier and encoder
Once you have established communications between the software and the DMC-14XX, you are ready to connect the rest of the motion control system. The motion control system generally consists of an ICM-1460 Interface Module, a servo amplifier, and a motor to transform the current from the servo amplifier into torque for motion. Galil also offers the AMP-1460 Interface Module which is an ICM1460 equipped with a servo amplifier for a DC motor. A signal breakout board of some type is strongly recommended. If you are using a breakout board from a third party, consult the documentation for that board to insure proper system connection. If you are using the ICM-1460 or AMP-1460 with the DMC-14XX, connect the 37-pin cable between the controller and interconnect module. Here are the first steps for connecting a motion control system: Step A. Connect the motor to the amplifier with no connection to the controller. Consult the amplifier documentation for instructions regarding proper connections. Connect and turn on the amplifier power supply. If the amplifiers are operating properly, the motor should stand still even when the amplifiers are powered up. Step B. Connect the amplifier enable signal. Before making any connections from the amplifier to the controller, you need to verify that the ground level of the amplifier is either floating or at the same potential as earth. WARNING: When the amplifier ground is not isolated from the power line or when it has a different potential than that of the computer ground, serious damage may result to the computer controller and amplifier. If you are not sure about the potential of the ground levels, connect the two ground signals (amplifier ground and earth) by a 10 k resistor and measure the voltage across

18 i Chapter 2 Getting Started

DMC-14x5/6


the resistor. Only if the voltage is zero, proceed to connect the two ground signals directly. The amplifier enable signal is used by the controller to disable the motor. This signal is labeled AMPEN on the ICM-1460 and should be connected to the enable signal on the amplifier. Note that many amplifiers designate this signal as the INHIBIT signal. Use the command, MO, to disable the motor amplifiers - check to insure that the motor amplifiers have been disabled (often this is indicated by an LED on the amplifier). This signal changes under the following conditions: the watchdog timer activates, the motor-off command, MO, is given, or the OE1 command (Enable Off-On-Error) is given and the position error exceeds the error limit. As shown in Figure 3.1, AEN can be used to disable the amplifier for these conditions. The standard configuration of the AEN signal is TTL active high. In other words, the AEN signal will be high when the controller expects the amplifier to be enabled. The polarity and the amplitude can be changed if you are using the ICM-1460 interface board. To change the polarity from active high (5 volts = enable, zero volts = disable) to active low (zero volts = enable, 5 volts = disable), replace the 7407 IC with a 7406. Note that many amplifiers designate the enable input as `inhibit'. To change the voltage level of the AEN signal, note the state of jumper at location JP1 on the ICM-1460. When a jumper is placed across AEN and 5V, the output voltage is 0-5V. To change to 12 volts, pull the jumper and rotate it so that AEN is connected to +12V. If you remove the jumper, the output signal is an open collector, allowing the user to connect an external supply with voltages up to 24V. Step C. Connect the encoders For stepper motor operation, an encoder is optional. For servo motor operation, if you have a preferred definition of the forward and reverse directions, make sure that the encoder wiring is consistent with that definition. The DMC-14XX accepts single-ended or differential encoder feedback with or without an index pulse. If you are not using the AMP-1460 or the ICM-1460, you will need to consult the appendix for the encoder pin outs for connection to the motion controller. The AMP-1460 and the ICM-1460 can accept encoder feedback from a 10-pin ribbon cable or individual signal leads. For a 10-pin ribbon cable encoder, connect the cable to the protected header connector labeled JP2. For individual wires, simply match the leads from the encoder you are using to the encoder feedback inputs on the interconnect board. The signal leads are labeled CHA, CHB, and INDEX. These labels represent channel A, channel B, and the INDEX pulse, respectively. For differential encoders, the complement signals are labeled CHA-, CHB-, and INDEX-. Note: When using pulse and direction encoders, the pulse signal is connected to CHA and the direction signal is connected to CHB. The controller must be configured for pulse and direction with the command CE. See the command summary for further information on the command CE. Step D. Verify proper encoder operation. Once the encoder is connected as described above, turn the motor shaft and interrogate the position with the instruction TP . The controller response will vary as the motor is turned. At this point, if TP does not vary with encoder rotation, there are three possibilities: 1. The encoder connections are incorrect - check the wiring as necessary. 2. The encoder has failed - using an oscilloscope, observe the encoder signals. Verify that both channels A and B have a peak magnitude between 5 and 12 volts. Note that if only one encoder channel fails, the position reporting varies by one count only. If

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 2 Getting Started i 19


the encoder failed, replace the encoder. If you cannot observe the encoder signals, try a different encoder. 3. There is a hardware failure in the controller - connect the same encoder to a different axis. If the problem disappears, you probably have a hardware failure. Consult the factory for help. Step E. Connect Hall Sensors if available (sinusoidal commutation only) Please consult factory before operating with sinusoidal commutation. Hall sensors are only used with sinusoidal commutation on the DMC-1415 and are not necessary for proper operation. The use of hall sensors allows the controller to automatically estimate the commutation phase upon reset and also provides the controller the ability to set a more precise commutation phase. Without hall sensors, the commutation phase must be determined manually. The hall effect sensors are connected to the digital inputs of the controller. These inputs can be used with the general purpose inputs (bits 1 - 7). Each set of inputs must use inputs that are in consecutive order. The input lines are specified with the command, BI. For example, if the Hall sensors are connected to inputs 5, 6 and 7, use the instruction: BI5

Step 8a. Connect Standard Servo Motor
The following discussion applies to connecting the DMC-14XX controller to standard servo motor amplifiers: The motor and the amplifier may be configured in the torque or the velocity mode. In the torque mode, the amplifier gain should be such that a 10 Volt signal generates the maximum required current. In the velocity mode, a command signal of 10 Volts should run the motor at the maximum required speed. Step by step directions on servo system setup are also included on the WSDK (Windows Servo Design Kit) software offered by Galil. See section on WSDK for more details. Check the Polarity of the Feedback Loop It is assumed that the motor and amplifier are connected together and that the encoder is operating correctly (Step D). Before connecting the motor amplifiers to the controller, read the following discussion on setting Error Limits and Torque Limits. Step A. Set the Error Limit as a Safety Precaution Usually, there is uncertainty about the correct polarity of the feedback. The wrong polarity causes the motor to run away from the starting position. Using a terminal program, such as DMCTERM, the following parameters can be given to avoid system damage: Input the commands: ER 2000 OE 1 Sets error limit to be 2000 counts Disables amplifier when excess error exists

If the motor runs away and creates a position error of 2000 counts, the motor amplifier will be disabled. Note: This function requires the AEN signal to be connected from the controller to the amplifier. Step B. Setting Torque Limit as a Safety Precaution

20 i Chapter 2 Getting Started

DMC-14x5/6


To limit the maximum voltage signal to your amplifier, the DMC-141X controller has a torque limit command, TL. This command sets the maximum voltage output of the controller and can be used to avoid excessive torque or speed when initially setting up a servo system. When operating an amplifier in torque mode, the voltage output of the controller will be directly related to the torque output of the motor. The user is responsible for determining this relationship using the documentation of the motor and amplifier. The torque limit can be set to a value that will limit the motors output torque. When operating an amplifier in velocity or voltage mode, the voltage output of the controller will be directly related to the velocity of the motor. The user is responsible for determining this relationship using the documentation of the motor and amplifier. The torque limit can be set to a value that will limit the speed of the motor. For example, the following command will limit the output of the controller to 1 volt: TL 1 Sets torque limit to 1 Volt Note: Once the correct polarity of the feedback loop has been determined, the torque limit should, in general, be increased to the default value of 9.99. The servo will not operate properly if the torque limit is below the normal operating range. See description of TL in the command reference. Step C. Disable motor Issue the motor off command to disable the motor. MO Step D. Connecting the Motor Once the parameters have been set, connect the analog motor command signal (ACMD) to the amplifier input. Issue the servo here command to turn the motors on. To test the polarity of the feedback, command a move with the instruction: SH PR 1000 BG Servo Here to turn motors on Position relative 1000 counts Begin motion Turns motor off

When the polarity of the feedback is wrong, the motor will attempt to run away. The controller should disable the motor when the position error exceeds 2000 counts. In this case, the polarity of the loop must be inverted. Inverting the Loop Polarity When the polarity of the feedback is incorrect, the user must invert the loop polarity and this may be accomplished by several methods. If you are driving a brush-type DC motor, the simplest way is to invert the two motor wires (typically red and black). For example, switch the M1 and M2 connections going from your amplifier to the motor. When driving a brushless motor, the polarity reversal may be done with the encoder. If you are using a single-ended encoder, interchange the signal CHA and CHB. If, on the other hand, you are using a differential encoder, interchange only CHA+ and CHA-. The loop polarity and encoder polarity can also be affected through software with the MT, and CE commands. For more details on the MT command or the CE command, see the Command Reference section. Sometimes the feedback polarity is correct (the motor does not attempt to run away) but the direction of motion is reversed with respect to the commanded motion. If this is the case, reverse the motor leads AND the encoder signals.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 2 Getting Started i 21


If the motor moves in the required direction but stops short of the target, it is most likely due to insufficient torque output from the motor command signal ACMD. This can be alleviated by reducing system friction on the motors. The instruction: TT Tell torque reports the level of the output signal. It will show a non-zero value that is below the friction level. Once you have established that you have closed the loop with the correct polarity, you can move on to the compensation phase (servo system tuning) to adjust the PID filter parameters, KP, KD and KI. It is necessary to accurately tune your servo system to ensure fidelity of position and minimize motion oscillation as described in the next section.

AMP-1460

Description Channel Channel Channel Channel Index Index + Gnd +5V A+ B+ AB-

Connection MA+ MB+ MAMBII+ GND 5V

Power Supply

VAMP+ Motor 1 AMPGND

Motor
Motor 2

Figure 2.4 - System Connections with the AMP-1460 Amplifier

22 i Chapter 2 Getting Started

DMC-14x5/6


I C M - 1460

ACMD

AMPEN GND

D es c r i pt i on C hannel C hannel C hannel C hannel I ndex I ndex + Gn d +5V A B A B + + -

C onnec t i on MA MB MA MB II+ GN 5V + + D

Re d W i r e Bl a c k W i r e

R ed C onnec t or

B l ac k C onnec t or

11 I N H I B I T 4 + R E F IN 2 SI G N AL G N D

Figure 2.5 - System Connections with a separate amplifier (MSA 12-80). This diagram shows the connections for a standard DC Servo Motor and encoder.

Step 8b. Connect brushless motor for sinusoidal commutation (DMC- 1415 only)
Please consult the factory before operating with sinusoidal commutation. The sinusoidal commutation option is available only on the DMC-1415. When using sinusoidal commutation, the parameters for the commutation must be determined and saved in the controllers non-volatile memory. The servo can then be tuned as described in Step 9. Step A. Disable the motor amplifier Use the command, MO, to disable the motor amplifiers. Step B. Connect the motor amplifier to the controller. The sinusoidal commutation amplifier requires 2 signals, usually denoted as Phase A & Phase B. These inputs should be connected to the two sinusoidal signals generated by the controller. The first signal is the main controller motor output, ACMD. The second signal utilizes the second DAC on the controller and is brought out on the ICM-1460 at pin 38 (ACMD2).

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 2 Getting Started i 23


It is not necessary to be concerned with cross-wiring the 1st and 2nd signals. If this wiring is incorrect, the setup procedure will alert the user (Step D). Step C. Specify the Size of the Magnetic Cycle. Use the command, BM, to specify the size of the brushless motors magnetic cycle in encoder counts. For example, if you are using a linear motor where the magnetic cycle length is 62 mm, and the encoder resolution is 1 micron, the cycle equals 62,000 counts. This can be commanded with the command: BM 62000 On the other hand, if you are using a rotary motor with 4000 counts per revolution and 3 magnetic cycles per revolution (three pole pairs) the command is BM 1333.333 Step D. Test the Polarity of the DACs and Hall Sensor Configuration. Use the brushless motor setup command, BS, to test the polarity of the output DACs. This command applies a certain voltage, V, to each phase for some time T, and checks to see if the motion is in the correct direction. The user must specify the value for V and T. For example, the command BS 2,700 will test the brushless axis with a voltage of 2 volts, applying it for 700 millisecond for each phase. In response, this test indicates whether the DAC wiring is correct and will indicate an approximate value of BM. If the wiring is correct, the approximate value for BM will agree with the value used in the previous step. Note: In order to properly conduct the brushless setup, the motor must be allowed to move a minimum of one magnetic cycle in both directions. Note: When using Galil Windows software, the timeout must be set to a minimum of 10 seconds (time-out = 10000) when executing the BS command. This allows the software to retrieve all messages returned from the controller. If Hall Sensors are Available: Since the Hall sensors are connected randomly, it is very likely that they are wired in the incorrect order. The brushless setup command indicates the correct wiring of the Hall sensors. The hall sensor wires should be re-configured to reflect the results of this test. The setup command also reports the position offset of the hall transition point and the zero phase of the motor commutation. The zero transition of the Hall sensors typically occurs at 0°, 30° or 90° of the phase commutation. It is necessary to inform the controller about the offset of the Hall sensor and this is done with the instruction, BB. Step E. Save Brushless Motor Configuration It is very important to save the brushless motor configuration in non-volatile memory. After the motor wiring and setup parameters have been properly configured, the burn command, BN, should be given. If Hall Sensors are Not Available: Without hall sensors, the controller will motor. In this case, the controller could using the BZ command (see next step). given before executing the BN comman reset and the commutation phase can be not be able to estimate the commutation phase of the brushless become unstable until the commutation phase has been set It is highly recommended that the motor off command be d. In this case, the motor will be disabled upon power up or set before enabling the motor.

Step F. Set Zero Commutation Phase

24 i Chapter 2 Getting Started

DMC-14x5/6


When an axis has been defined as sinusoidally commutated, the controller must have an estimate for commutation phase. When hall sensors are used, the controller automatically estimates this value upon reset of the controller. If no hall sensors are used, the controller will not be able to make this estimate and the commutation phase must be set before enabling the motor. If Hall Sensors are Not Available: To initialize the commutation without Hall effect sensor use the command, BZ. This function drives the motor to a position where the commutation phase is zero, and sets the phase to zero. The BZ command argument is a real number which represents the voltage to be applied to the amplifier during the initialization. When the voltage is specified by a positive number, the initialization process will end up in the motor off (MO) state. A negative number causes the process to end in the Servo Here (SH) state. Warning: This command must move the motor to find the zero commutation phase. This movement is instantaneous and will cause the system to jerk. Larger applied voltages will cause more severe motor jerk. The applied voltage will typically be sufficient for proper operation of the BZ command. For systems with significant friction, this voltage may need to be increased and for systems with very small motors, this value should be decreased. For example, BZ -2 will drive the axis to zero, using a 2V signal. The controller will then leave the motor enabled. For systems that have external forces working against the motor, such as gravity, the BZ argument must provide a torque 10x the external force. If the torque is not sufficient, the commutation zero may not be accurate. If Hall Sensors are Available: The estimated value of the commutation phase is good to within 30°. This estimate can be used to drive the motor but a more accurate estimate is needed for efficient motor operation. There are 3 possible methods for commutation phase initialization: Method 1. Use the BZ command as described above. Method 2. Drive the motor close to commutation phase of zero and then use BZ command. This method decreases the amount of system jerk by moving the motor close to zero commutation phase before executing the BZ command. The controller makes an estimate for the number of encoder counts between the current position and the position of zero commutation phase. This value is stored in the operand _BZx. Using this operand the controller can be commanded to move the motor. The BZ command is then issued as described above. For example, to initialize the X axis motor upon power or reset, the following commands may be given: SH PRX=-1*(_BZX) BG AM BZX=-1 Enable X axis motor Move X motor close to zero commutation phase Begin motion on X axis Wait for motion to complete on X axis Drive motor to commutation phase zero and leave motor on

Method 3. Use the command, BC. This command uses the hall transitions to determine the commutation phase. Ideally, the hall sensor transitions will be separated by exactly 60° and any deviation from 60° will affect the accuracy of this method. If the hall sensors are accurate, this method is recommended. The BC command monitors the hall sensors during a move and monitors the Hall sensors for a transition point. When

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 2 Getting Started i 25


that occurs, the controller computes the commutation phase and sets it. For example, to initialize the motor upon power or reset, the following commands may be given: SH BC PR 50000 BG Enable motor Enable the brushless calibration command Command a relative position movement Begin motion. When the hall sensors detect a phase transition, the commutation phase is re-set.

Step 8c. Connect Step Motors
In Stepper Motor operation, the pulse output signal has a 50% duty cycle. Step motors operate open loop and do not require encoder feedback. When a stepper is used, the auxiliary encoder for the corresponding axis is unavailable for an external connection. If an encoder is used for position feedback, connect the encoder to the main encoder input corresponding to that axis. The commanded position of the stepper can be interrogated with RP or DE. The encoder position can be interrogated with TP. The frequency of the step motor pulses can be smoothed with the filter parameter, KS. The KS parameter has a range between 0.5 and 8, where 8 implies the largest amount of smoothing. See Command Reference regarding KS. The DMC-14XX profiler commands the step motor amplifier. All DMC-141X motion commands apply such as PR, PA, VP, CR and JG. The acceleration, deceleration, slew speed and smoothing are also used. Since step motors run open-loop, the PID filter does not function and the position error is not generated. To connect step motors with the DMC-14XX6 you must follow this procedure: Step A. Install SMX and SD jumpers In order for the DMC-141X to operate in stepper mode, the corresponding stepper motor jumper installed. For a discussion of SM jumpers, see section Step 2. Install jumpers on the DMC-141X. Step B. Connect step and direction signals from controller to motor amplifier Connect the step and direction signals from the controller to respective signals on your step motor amplifier. (The step and direction signals are labeled ACMD (pwm) and ACMD2 (sign) respectively on the ICM-1460). Consult the documentation for your step motor amplifier. Step C. Configure DMC-141X for motor type using MT command. You can configure the DMC-141X for active high or active low pulses. Use the command MT 2 for active low step motor pulses and MT -2 for active high step motor pulses. See description of the MT command in the Command Reference.

Step 8d. Connect brush or brushless servo motor to DMC-1416
The DMC-1416 provides an integrated brush or brushless amplifier and DC to DC converter to be used with DC brush or brushless motors. Warning: The DMC-1416 is powered up in the motor on (SH) condition unless the MO jumper is selected. It is recommended that this jumper be installed (see Step 2. "Configuring Jumpers on the DMC-14XX") for the initial power up of the system. This will prevent runaway of the system due to positive feedback. This jumper can then be removed once polarity has been configured properly. To connect the DC brush or brushless motor, follow this procedure:

26 i Chapter 2 Getting Started

DMC-14x5/6


Step A. Disconnect controller power Unplug the 5-pin power connector (J5) from the front of the DMC-1416. This will power down the controller so that the motor may be connected. Step B. Connect DC brush or brushless motor If using the DMC-1416 with the brush amplifier, connect the motor leads to the corresponding screw terminals on the 5-pin power connector labeled M+ and M-. If using the DMC-1416 with the brushless amplifier, connect the three phases to the respective screw terminals on the 5-pin power connector labeled A, B and C. In addition, the Hall effect sensors must be connected to the controller for proper phase initialization. These are connected to the corresponding pins on the 15 Pin-D connecter (J5) labeled Hall 1, Hall 2 and Hall 3. It is assumed that the encoder is already connected to the ICM-1460 or the 15 Pin-D connector and verified operational. Step C. Reconnect power to controller Reconnect the 5-pin power connector to the DMC-1416 (20 ­ 60VDC). This will power the motor and allow communication with the controller. Test the communication by sending the TP command and receiving a valid response. Step D. Test polarity of the feedback loop With the hardware connections complete, the next step is to test the polarity of the feedback loop to limit a runaway situation. For this procedure, please refer to Step 8a. Connect Standard Servo Motor for the section Check the Polarity of the Feedback Loop. Note: Before the PR moves are issued in the tests, but after the error limits have been set, the SH command needs to be sent to turn on the servo motor.

Step 9. Tune the Servo System
The system compensation provides fast and accurate response by adjusting the filter parameters. The following presentation suggests a simple and easy way for compensation. More advanced design methods are available with software design tools from Galil, such as the Windows Servo Design Kit (WSDK software). If the torque limit was set as a safety precaution in the previous step, you may want to increase this value. See Step B of the above section "Setting Torque Limit as a Safety Precaution" The filter has three parameters: the damping, KD; the proportional gain, KP; and the integrator, KI. The parameters should be selected in this order. To start, set the integrator to zero with the instruction KI 0 KP 1 KD 100 Integrator gain Proportional gain Derivative gain and set the proportional gain to a low value, such as

For more damping, you can increase KD (maximum is 4095). Increase gradually and stop after the motor vibrates. A vibration is noticed by audible sound or by interrogation. If you send the command TE Tell error a few times, and get varying responses, especially with reversing polarity, it indicates system vibration. When this happens, simply reduce KD.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 2 Getting Started i 27


Next you need to increase the value of KP gradually (maximum allowed is 1023). You can monitor the improvement in the response with the Tell Error instruction KP 10 TE Proportion gain Tell error

As the proportional gain is increased, the error decreases. Again, the system may vibrate if the gain is too high. In this case, reduce KP. Typically, KP should not be greater than KD/4. Finally, to select KI, start with zero value and increase it gradually. The integrator eliminates the position error, resulting in improved accuracy. Therefore, the response to the instruction becomes zero. As KI is increased, its effect is amplified and it may lead to vibrations. If this occurs, simply reduce KI. For a more detailed description of the operation of the PID filter and/or servo system theory, see Chapter 10 Theory of Operation.

Design Examples
Here are a few examples for tuning and using your controller.

Example 1 - System Set-up
This example assigns the system filter parameters, error limits and enables the automatic error shut-off. Instruction Interpretation
KP 10 KD 100 KI 1 EO 1 ER 1000 Set proportional gain Set damping Set integral Set error off Set error limit

Example 2 - Profiled Move
Objective: Rotate a distance of 10,000 counts at a slew speed of 20,000 counts/sec and an acceleration and deceleration rates of 100,000 counts/s2. Instruction Interpretation
PR 10000 SP 20000 DC 100000 AC 100000 BG Distance Speed Deceleration Acceleration Start Motion

In response, the motor turns and stops.

Example 3 - Position Interrogation
The position of the axis may be interrogated with the instruction

28 i Chapter 2 Getting Started

DMC-14x5/6


TP

Tell position

which returns the position of the main encoder. The position error, which is the difference between the commanded position and the actual position can be interrogated by the instructions
TE Tell error

Example 4 - Absolute Position
Objective: Command motion by specifying the absolute position. Instruction Interpretation
DP 0 PA 7000 BG Define the current position as 0 Sets the desired absolute position Start motion

Example 5 - Velocity Control (Jogging)
Objective: Drive the motor at specified speeds. Instruction Interpretation
JG 10000 AC 100000 DC 50000 BG JG -40000 TV Set Jog Speed Set acceleration Set deceleration Start motion New speed and Direction Returns speed

after a few seconds, command:

This causes velocity changes including direction reversal. The motion can be stopped with the instruction
ST Stop

Example 6 - Operation Under Torque Limit
The magnitude of the motor command may be limited independently by the instruction TL. The following program illustrates that effect. Instruction Interpretation
TL 0.2 JG 10000 BG Set output limit to 0.2 volts Set speed Start motion

The motor will probably not move as the output signal is not sufficient to overcome the friction. If the motion starts, it can be stopped easily by a touch of a finger. Increase the torque level gradually by instructions such as
TL 1.0 TL 9.98 Increase torque limit to 1 volt. Increase torque limit to maximum, 9.98 Volts.

The maximum level of 10 volts provides the full output torque.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 2 Getting Started i 29


Example 7 - Interrogation
The values of the parameters may be interrogated using a ?. For example, the instruction
KP ? Return gain

The same procedure applies to other parameters such as KI, KD, FA, etc.

Example 8 - Operation in the Buffer Mode
The instructions may be buffered before execution as shown below. Instruction Interpretation
PR 600000 SP 10000 WT 10000 BG Distance Speed Wait 10000 milliseconds before reading the next instruction Start the motion

Example 9 - Motion Programs
Motion programs may be edited and stored in the memory. They may be executed at a later time. The instruction
ED Edit mode

moves the operation to the editor mode where the program may be written and edited. For example, in response to the first ED command, the Galil Windows software will open a simple editor window. From this window, the user can type in the following program:
#A PR 700 SP 2000 BG EN Define label Distance Speed Start motion End program

This program can be downloaded to the controller by selecting the File menu option download. Once this is done, close the editor. Now the program may be executed with the command
XQ #A Start the program running

Example 10 - Motion Programs with Loops
Motion programs may include conditional jumps as shown below. Instruction Interpretation
#A DP 0 V1=1000 #Loop PA V1 BG AM WT 500 TP Label Define current position as zero Set initial value of V1 Label for loop Move motor V1 counts Start motion After motion is complete Wait 500 ms Tell position

30 i Chapter 2 Getting Started

DMC-14x5/6


V1=V1+1000 JP #Loop,V1<10001 EN XQ #A

Increase the value of V1 Repeat if V1<10001 End Execute Program #A

After the above program is entered, quit the Editor Mode, Q. To start the motion, command:

Example 11- Motion Programs with Trippoints
The motion programs may include trippoints as shown below. Instruction Interpretation
#B DP PR 30000 SP 5000 BG AD 4000 TP EN XQ #B Label Define initial position Set target Set speed Start motion Wait until X moved 4000 Tell position End program Execute Program #B

To start the program, command:

Example 12 - Control Variables
Objective: To show how control variables may be utilized. Instruction Interpretation
#A;DP0 PR 4000 SP 2000 BG AM WT 500 #B V1 = _TP PR -V1/2 BG AM WT 500 V1= JP #C, V1=0 JP #B #C;EN XQ #A Determine distance to zero Command move 1/2 the distance Start motion After motion Wait 500 ms Report the value of V1 Exit if position=0 Repeat otherwise End Execute Program #A Label; Define current position as zero Initial position Set speed Move Wait until move is complete Wait 500 ms

To start the program, command

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 2 Getting Started i 31


This program moves the motor to an initial position of 1000 and returns it to zero on increments of half the distance. Note, _TP is an internal variable which returns the value of the position. Internal variables may be created by preceding a DMC-141X instruction with an underscore, _.

Example 13 - Control Variables and Offset
Objective: Illustrate the use of variables in iterative loops and use of multiple instructions on one line. Instruction Interpretation
#A KI0 DP0 V1=8; V2=0 #B OF V1 WT 200 V2=_TP JP#C,@ABS[V2]<2 MG V2 V1=V1-1 JP #B #C;EN Initializing variables to be used by program Program label #B Set offset value Wait 200 msec Set variable V2 to the current position Exit if error small Report value of V2 Decrease Offset Return to top of program End Set initial values

This program starts with a large offset and gradually decreases its value, resulting in decreasing error.

32 i Chapter 2 Getting Started

DMC-14x5/6


Chapter 3 Connecting Hardware

Overview
The DMC-1415 and DMC-1416 provide digital inputs for forward limit, reverse limit, home and abort signals. The controller also has 7 uncommitted, TTL inputs (for general use), 3 TTL outputs and 2 analog inputs (12-bit). The DMC-1425 provides digital inputs for X and Y forward limit, X and Y reverse limit, X and Y home input and abort input. The controller also has 3 uncommitted, TTL inputs, 3 TTL outputs and 2 analog inputs (12-bit). This chapter describes the inputs and outputs and their proper connection.

Using Inputs
Limit Switch Input
The forward limit switch (FLSx) inhibits motion in the forward direction immediately upon activation of the switch. The reverse limit switch (RLSx) inhibits motion in the reverse direction immediately upon activation of the switch. If a limit switch is activated during motion, the controller will make a decelerated stop using the deceleration rate previously set with the DC command. The motor will remain on (in a servo state) after the limit switch has been activated and will hold motor position. To set the activation state of the limit switches refer to the command CN, configure, in the Command Reference. When a forward or reverse limit switch is activated, the current application program that is running will be interrupted and the controller will automatically jump to the #LIMSWI subroutine if one exists. This is a subroutine which the user can include in any motion control program and is useful for executing specific instructions upon activation of a limit switch. After a limit switch has been activated, further motion in the direction of the limit switch will not be possible until the logic state of the switch returns back to an inactive state. This usually involves physically opening the tripped switch. Any attempt at further motion before the logic state has been reset will result in the following error: "022 - Begin not possible due to limit switch" error. The operands, _LFx and _LRx, return the state of the forward and reverse limit switches, respectively (x represents the axis, X or Y). The value of the operand is either a `0' or `1' corresponding to the logic state of the limit switch, active or inactive, respectively. If the limit switches are configured for active low (CN-1), no connection or a 5V input will be read as a `1', while grounding the switch will return a `0'. If the limit switches are configured for active high (CN1), the reading will be inverted and no connection or a 5V input will be read as a `0', while grounding the switch will return a `1'. Using a terminal program, the state of a limit switch can be printed to the screen with the command, MG _LFx or MG _LRx. This prints the value of the limit switch operands for the 'x' axis. The logic state of the limit switches can also be interrogated with the TS command. For more details on TS, _LFx, _LRx, or MG, see the Command Reference.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 3 Connecting Hardware i 33


Home Switch Input
Homing inputs are designed to provide mechanical reference points for a motion control application. A transition in the state of a Home input alerts the controller that a particular reference point has been reached by a moving part in the motion control system. A reference point can be a point in space or an encoder index pulse. The Home input detects any transition in the state of the switch and changes between logic states 0 and 1, corresponding to either 0V or 5V depending on the configuration set by the user (CN command). The CN command can be used to customize the homing routine to the user's application. There are three homing routines supported by the DMC-14XX: Find Edge (FE), Find Index (FI), and Standard Home (HM). The Find Edge routine is initiated by the command sequence: FEX , BGX (where X could be any axis on the controller, X or Y). The Find Edge routine will cause the motor to accelerate then slew at constant speed until a transition is detected in the logic state of the Home input. The direction of the FE motion is dependent on the state of the home switch. Refer to the CN command to set the correspondence between the Home Input voltage and motion direction. The motor will decelerate to a stop when a transition is seen on the input. The acceleration rate, deceleration rate and slew speed are specified by the user, prior to the movement, using the commands AC, DC, and SP. It is recommended that a high deceleration value be used so the motor will decelerate rapidly after sensing the Home switch. The Find Index routine is initiated by the command sequence: FIX , BGX (where X could be any axis on the controller, X or Y). Find Index will cause the motor to accelerate to the user-defined slew speed (SP) at a rate specified by the user with the AC command and slew until the controller senses a change in the index pulse signal from low to high. The motor then decelerates to a stop at the rate previously specified by the user with the DC command. Although Find Index is an option for homing, it is not dependent upon a transition in the logic state of the Home input, but instead is dependent upon a transition in the level of the index pulse signal. The Standard Homing routine is initiated by the sequence of commands HMX , BGX (where X could be any axis on the controller, X or Y). Standard Homing is a combination of Find Edge and Find Index homing. Initiating the standard homing routine will cause the motor to slew until a transition is detected in the logic state of the Home input. The motor will accelerate at the rate specified by the command, AC, up to the slew speed. After detecting the transition in the logic state on the Home Input, the motor will decelerate to a stop at the rate specified by the command DC. After the motor has decelerated to a stop, it switches direction and approaches the transition point at the speed of 256 counts/sec. When the logic state changes again, the motor moves forward (in the direction of increasing encoder count) at the same speed, until the controller senses the index pulse. After detection, it decelerates to a stop and defines this position as 0. The logic state of the Home input can be interrogated with the command MG _HMX. This command returns a 0 or 1 if the logic state is low or high (dependent on the CN command). The state of the Home input can also be interrogated indirectly with the TS command. For examples and further information about Homing, see command HM, FI, FE of the Command Reference and the section entitled `Homing' in the Programming Motion Section of this manual.

Abort Input
The function of the Abort input is to immediately stop the controller upon transition of the logic state. NOTE: The response of the abort input is significantly different from the response of an activated limit switch. When the abort input is activated, the controller stops generating motion commands immediately, whereas the limit switch response causes the controller to make a decelerated stop. NOTE: The effect of an Abort input is dependent on the state of the off-on-error function for each axis. If the Off-On-Error function is enabled for any given axis, the motor for that axis will be turned off when the abort signal is generated. This could cause the motor to `coast' to a stop since it is no

34 i Chapter 3 Connecting Hardware

DMC-14x5/6


longer under servo control. If the Off-On-Error function is disabled, the motor will decelerate to a stop as fast as mechanically possible and the motor will remain in a servo state. All motion programs that are currently running are terminated when a transition in the Abort input is detected. For information on setting the Off-On-Error function, see the Command Reference, OE.

Uncommitted Digital Inputs
The general use inputs are TTL and are accessible through the ICM-1460 or AMP-1460 as IN1 ­ IN7. The inputs can be accessed directly from the 37 Pin-D cable or connector on the controller, also. For a description of the pin outs, consult the appendix. These inputs can be interrogated with the use of the command TI (Tell Inputs), the operand _TI and the function @IN[n] (See Chapter 7, Mathematical Functions and Expressions). NOTE: For systems using the ICM-1460 or AMP-1460 interconnect module, there is an option to provide opto-isolation on the inputs. In this case, the user provides an isolated power supply (+5V to +24V and ground). For more information, consult Galil.

Amplifier Interface
The DMC-14XX analog command voltage, ACMD, ranges between +/-10V. This signal, along with GND, provides the input to the power amplifiers. The power amplifiers must be sized to drive the motors and load. For best performance, the amplifiers should be configured for a current mode of operation with no additional compensation. The gain should be set such that a 10 Volt input results in the maximum required current. If the controller is operating in stepper mode, the pulse and direction signals will be input into a stepper drive. The DMC-14XX also provides an amplifier enable following conditions: the watchdog timer activates, OE1command (Enable Off-On-Error) is given and shown in Figure 3.1, AEN can be used to disable th signal, AEN. This signal is activated under the the motor-off command, MO, is given, or the the position error exceeds the error limit. As e amplifier for these conditions.

The standard configuration of the AEN signal is TTL active high. In this configuration the AEN signal will be high when the controller expects the amplifier to be enabled. The polarity and the amplitude can be changed if you are using the ICM-1460 interface board. To change the polarity from active high (5 volts= enable, zero volts = disable) to active low (zero volts = enable, 5 volts= disable), replace the 7407 IC with a 7406. Note that many amplifiers designate the enable input as `inhibit'. To change the voltage level of the AEN signal, note the state of the jumper on the ICM/AMP-1460. When JP4 has a jumper from "AEN" to "5V" (default setting), the output voltage is 0-5V. To change to 12 volts, pull the jumper out and rotate it so that it connects the pins marked "AEN" and "+12V". If the jumper is removed entirely, the output is an open collector, allowing the user to connect an external supply with voltages up to 24V. To connect an external 24V supply, 2.2k resistor in series between the interconnect (AMPEN). Then wire to the ground, GND, of the intercon amplifier. remove the jumper JP4 from the interconnect board. Connect a +24V of the supply and the amplifier enable terminal on the the AMPEN to the enable pin on the amplifier. Connect the -24V nect and connect the GND of the interconnect to the GND of the

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 3 Connecting Hardware i 35


DMC-14XX

ICM-1460
+12V +5V

Connection to +5V or +12V made through jumper at JP4. Removing the jumper allows the user to connect a load (e.g. optoisolator or relay) between AMPEN and their own supply at the desired voltage level (up to 24V).

AMPEN GND

SERVO MOTOR AMPLIFIER

37-Pin Cable

ACMD

7407 Open Collector Buffer. The Enable signal can be inverted by using a 7406.

Analog Switch

Figure 3.1 - Connecting AEN to the motor amplifier

TTL Inputs
As previously mentioned, the DMC-14XX has 7 uncommitted TTL level inputs. The command @IN, or TI will read the state of the inputs. For more information on these commands refer to the Command Reference. The reset input is also a TTL level, non-isolated signal and is used to locally reset the DMC-14XX without resetting the PC.

Analog Inputs
The DMC-14XX has 2 analog inputs configured for the range between ­10V and +10V. The inputs are decoded by a 12-bit ADC giving a voltage resolution of approximately .005V. The impedance of these inputs is 10Kohms. The analog inputs are specified as @AN[n] where n is the number 1 or 2.

TTL Outputs
The DMC-14XX provides three general use outputs, an output compare and 4 status outputs. The general use outputs are TTL and are accessible through the ICM-1460 as OUT1 thru OUT3. These outputs can be turned On and Off with the commands, SB (Set Bit), CB (Clear Bit), OB (Output Bit), and OP (Output Port). For more information about these commands, see the Command

36 i Chapter 3 Connecting Hardware

DMC-14x5/6


Reference. The value of the outputs can be checked with the operand _OP and the function @OUT[] (see Chapter 7, Mathematical Functions and Expressions). The output compare signal is TTL and is available on the ICM-1460 as CMP. Output compare is controlled by the position of any of the main encoders on the controller. The output can be programmed to produce an active low pulse (1usec) based on an incremental encoder value or to activate once when an axis position has been passed. For further information, see the command OC in the Command Reference. There are four status LEDs on the controller which indicate operating and error conditions on the controller. Below is a list of those LEDs and their functions. Green Power LED - The green status LED indicates that the +5V power has been applied properly to the controller. Red Status/Error LED - The red error LED will flash on initially at power up, and stay lit for approximately 1 ­ 8 seconds. After this initial power up condition, the LED will illuminate for the following reasons: 1. At least one axis has a position error greater than the error limit. The error limit is set by using the command ER. 2. The reset line on the controller is held low or is being affected by noise. 3. There is a failure on the controller and the processor is resetting itself. 4. There is a failure with the output IC which drives the error signal. Green Link LED ­ The second green LED is lit when there is an Ethernet connection to the controller. This LED tests only for the physical connection, not for an active or enabled link. Yellow Activity LED ­ The yellow LED indicates traffic across the Ethernet connection. This LED will show both transmit and receive activity across the connection. If there is no Ethernet connection or IP address assigned, the LED will flash at regular intervals to show that the BOOTP packets are being broadcast.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 3 Connecting Hardware i 37


THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK INTENTIONALLY

38 i Chapter 3 Connecting Hardware

DMC-14x5/6


Chapter 4 Communication

Introduction
The DMC-14XX has one RS232 port and one Ethernet port. The RS-232 port is the data set. The Ethernet port is a 10Base-T link. The RS-232 is a standard serial link with communication baud rates up to 19.2kbaud.

RS232 Port
The DMC-14XX has a single RS232 connection for sending and receiving commands from a PC or other terminal. The pin-outs for the RS232 connection are as follows.

RS232 - Port 1

DATATERM
1 CTS ­ output 2 Transmit Data - output 3 Receive Data - input 4 RTS ­ input 5 Ground 6 CTS ­ output 7 RTS ­ input 8 CTS ­ output 9 No connect (Can connect to +5V or sample clock)

RS-232 Configuration
Configure your PC for 8-bit data, one start-bit, one stop-bit, full duplex and no parity. The baud rate for the RS232 communication can be selected by selecting the proper jumper configuration on the DMC-14XX according to the table below. Baud Rate Selection JUMPER SETTINGS 96
OFF ON OFF

BAUD RATE -19200 9600 1200

12
OFF OFF ON

Handshaking Modes The RS232 port is configured for hardware handshaking. In this mode, the RTS and CTS lines are used. The CTS line will go high whenever the DMC-14XX is not ready to receive additional characters. The RTS line will inhibit the DMC-14XX from sending additional characters. Note: The

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 4 Communication i 39


RTS line goes high for inhibit. This handshake procedure ensures proper communication especially at higher baud rates.

Ethernet Configuration
Communication Protocols
The Ethernet is a local area network through which information is transferred in units known as packets. Communication protocols are necessary to dictate how these packets are sent and received. The DMC-14XX supports two industry standard protocols, TCP/IP and UDP/IP. The controller will automatically respond in the format in which it is contacted. TCP/IP is a "connection" protocol. The master must be connected to the slave in order to begin communicating. Each packet sent is acknowledged when received. If no acknowledgement is received, the information is assumed lost and is resent. Unlike TCP/IP, UDP/IP does not require a "connection". This protocol is similar to communicating via RS232. If information is lost, the controller does not return a colon or question mark. Because the protocol does not provide for lost information, the sender must re-send the packet. Although UDP/IP is more efficient and simple, Galil recommends using the TCP/IP protocol. TCP/IP insures that if a packet is lost or destroyed while in transit, it will be resent. Ethernet communication transfers information in `packets'. The packets must be limited to 470 data bytes or less. Larger packets could cause the controller to lose communication. NOTE: In order not to lose information in transit, Galil recommends that the user wait for an acknowledgement of receipt of a packet before sending the next packet.

Addressing
There are three levels of addresses that define Ethernet devices. The first is the Ethernet or hardware address. This is a unique and permanent 6 byte number. No other device will have the same Ethernet address. The DMC-14XX Ethernet address is set by the factory and the last two bytes of the address are the serial number of the controller. The second level of addressing is the IP address. This is a 32-bit (or 4 byte) number. The IP address is constrained by each local network and must be assigned locally. Assigning an IP address to the controller can be done in a number of ways. The first method is to use the BOOT-P utility via the Ethernet connection (the DMC-14XX must be connected to network and powered). For a brief explanation of BOOT-P, see the section: Third Party Software. Either a BOOT-P server on the internal network or the Galil terminal software may be used. To use the Galil BOOT-P utility, select the registry in the terminal emulator. NOTE: Select the DMC-1415 controller. Once the controller has been selected, enter the IP address and select either TCP/IP or UDP/IP as the protocol. When done, click on the ASSIGN IP ADDRESS. The Galil Terminal Software will respond with a list of all controllers on the network that do not currently have IP addresses. The user selects the controller and the software will assign the controller the specified IP address. Then enter the terminal and type in BN to save the IP address to the controller's non-volatile memory. CAUTION: Be sure that there is only one BOOT-P server running. If your network has DHCP or BOOT-P running, it may automatically assign an IP address to the controller upon linking it to the network. In order to ensure that the IP address is correct, please contact your system administrator before connecting the controller to the Ethernet network.

40 i Chapter 4 Communication

DMC-14x5/6


Ethernet Parameters Tab in Win 95/98

Ethernet Parameters Window in Win 98SE/2000/ME/NT 4/XP The second method for setting an IP address is to send the IA command through the DMC-14XX main RS-232 port. The IP address you want to assign may be entered as a 4 byte number delimited by commas (industry standard uses periods) or a signed 32 bit number (Ex. IA 124,51,29,31 or IA 2083724575). Type in BN to save the IP address to the controller's non-volatile memory.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 4 Communication i 41


NOTE: Galil strongly recommends that the IP address selected is not one that can be accessed across the Gateway. The Gateway is an application that controls communication between an internal network and the outside world. The third level of Ethernet addressing is the UDP or TCP port number. The Galil controller does not require a specific port number. The port number is established by the client or master each time it connects to the controller.

Communicating with Multiple Devices
The DMC-14XX is capable of supporting multiple masters and slaves. The masters may be multiple PC's that send commands to the controller. The slaves are typically peripheral I/O devices that receive commands from the controller. NOTE: The term "Master" is equivalent to the internet "client". The term "Slave" is equivalent to the internet "server". An Ethernet handle is a communication resource within a device. The DMC-14XX can have a maximum of 6 Ethernet handles open at any time. When using TCP/IP, each master or slave uses an individual Ethernet handle. In UDP/IP, one handle may be used for all the masters, but each slave uses one. (Pings and ARPs do not occupy handles.) If all 6 handles are in use and a 7th master tries to connect, it will be sent a "reset packet" that generates the appropriate error in its windows application. NOTE: There are a number of ways to reset the controller. Hardware reset (push reset button or power down controller) and software resets (through Ethernet or RS232 by entering RS). The only reset that will not cause the controller to disconnect is a software reset via the Ethernet. When the Galil controller acts as the master, the IH command is used to assign handles and connect to its slaves. The IP address may be entered as a 4 byte number separated with commas (industry standard uses periods) or as a signed 32 bit number. A port number may also be specified, but if it is not, it will default to 1000. The protocol (TCP/IP or UDP/IP) to use must also be designated at this time. Otherwise, the controller will not connect to the slave. (Ex. IHB=151,25,255,9<179>2 This will open handle #2 and connect to the IP address 151.25.255.9, port 179, using TCP/IP) An additional protocol layer is available for speaking to I/O devices. Modbus is an RS-485 protocol that packages information in binary packets that are sent as part of a TCP/IP packet. In this protocol, each slave has a 1 byte slave address. The DMC-14XX can use a specific slave address or default to the handle number. The Modbus protocol has a set of commands called function codes. The DMC-14XX supports the 10 major function codes: Function Code 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 15 16 17 Definition Read Coil Status (Read Bits) Read Input Status (Read Bits) Read Holding Registers (Read Words) Read Input Registers (Read Words) Force Single Coil (Write One Bit) Preset Single Register (Write One Word) Read Exception Status (Read Error Code) Force Multiple Coils (Write Multiple Bits) Preset Multiple Registers (Write Words) Report Slave ID

42 i Chapter 4 Communication

DMC-14x5/6


The DMC-14XX provides three levels of Modbus communication. The first level allows the user to create a raw packet and receive raw data. It uses the MBh command with a function code of ­1. The format of the command is MBh = -1,len,array[] where len is the number of bytes array[] is the array with the data The second level incorporates the Modbus structure. This is necessary for sending configuration and special commands to an I/O device. The formats vary depending on the function code that is called. For more information refer to the Command Reference. The third level of Modbus communication uses standard Galil commands. Once the slave has been configured, the commands that may be used are @IN[], @AN[], SB, CB, OB, and AO. For example, AO 2020,8.2 would tell I/O number 2020 to output 8.2 volts. If a specific slave address is not necessary, the I/O number to be used can be calculated with the following: I/O Number = (HandleNum*1000) +((Module-1)*4) + (BitNum-1) Where HandleNum is the handle number from 1 (A) to 6 (F). Module is the position of the module in the rack from 1 to 16. BitNum is the I/O point in the module from 1 to 4. If an explicit slave address is to be used, the equation becomes: I/O Number = (SlaveAddress*10000) + (HandleNum*1000) +((Module-1)*4) + (Bitnum-1) To view an example procedure for communicating with an OPTO-22 rack, refer to the appendix. Which devices receive what information from the controller depends on a number of things. If a device queries the controller, it will receive the response unless it explicitly tells the controller to send it to another device. If the command that generates a response is part of a downloaded program, the response will route to whichever port is specified as the default by the CF command. To designate a specific destination for the information, add {Eh} to the end of the command. (Ex. MG{EC}"Hello" will send the message "Hello" to handle #3. TP,,?{EF} will send the z axis position to handle #6.)

Multicasting
A multicast may only be used in UDP/IP and is similar to a broadcast (where everyone on the network gets the information) but specific to a group. In other words, all devices within a specified group will receive the information that is sent in a multicast. There can be many multicast groups on a network and are differentiated by their multicast IP address. To communicate with all the devices in a specific multicast group, the information can be sent to the multicast IP address rather than to each individual device IP address. All Galil controllers belong to a default multicast address of 239.255.19.56. The controller's multicast IP address can be changed by using the IA> u command.

Using Third Party Software
Galil supports ARP, BOOT-P, and Ping, which are utilities for establishing Ethernet connections. ARP is an application that determines the Ethernet (hardware) address of a device at a specific IP address. BOOT-P is an application that determines which devices on the network do not have an IP address and assigns the IP address you have chosen to it. Ping is used to check the communication between the device at a specific IP address and the host computer. The DMC-14XX can communicate with a host computer through any application that can send TCP/IP or UDP/IP packets. A good example of this is Telnet, a utility that comes with most Windows systems.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 4 Communication i 43


Data Record
The DMC-14x5 provide a block of status information with the use of a single command, QR. This command, along with the QZ command can be very useful for accessing complete controller status. The QR command will return 4 bytes of header information and specific blocks of information as specified by the command arguments: QR ABCDEFGHST Each argument corresponds to a block of information according to the Data Record Map below. If no argument is given, the entire data record map will be returned. Note that the data record size will depend on the number of axes.

Data Record Map
DATA TYPE
UB UB UB UB UW UB UB UB UB UB UB UB UB UB UB UB UB UB UB UB UB UB UB UB UB UB UB UW UW

ITEM
1 byte of header 2 byte of header 3rd byte of header 4rth byte of header sample number general input 0 general input 1 general input 2 general input 3 general input 4 general input 5 general input 6 general input 7 general input 8 general input 9 general output 0 general output 1 general output 2 general output 3 general output 4 general output 5 general output 6 general output 7 general output 8 general output 9 error code general status segment count of coordinated move for S plane coordinated move status for S plane
nd st

BLOCK
Header Header Header Header I block I block I block I block I block I block I block I block I block I block I block I block I block I block I block I block I block I block I block I block I block I block I block S block S block

44 i Chapter 4 Communication

DMC-14x5/6


SL UW UW SL UW UB UB SL SL SL SL SL SW SW UW UB UB SL SL SL SL SL SW SW

distance traveled in coordinated move for S plane segment count of coordinated move for T plane coordinated move status for T plane distance traveled in coordinated move for T plane a axis status a axis switches a axis stop code a axis reference position a axis motor position a axis position error a axis auxiliary position a axis velocity a axis torque a axis analog b axis status b axis switches b axis stop code b axis reference position b axis motor position b axis position error b axis auxiliary position b axis velocity b axis torque b axis analog

S block T block T block T block A block A block A block A block A block A block A block A block A block A block B block B block B block B block B block B block B block B block B block B block

NOTE: UB = Unsigned Byte, UW = Unsigned Word, SW = Signed Word, SL = Signed Long Word

Explanation of Status Information and Axis Switch Information
Header Information - Byte 0, 1 of Header: BIT 15 BIT 14 BIT 13 BIT 12 1 N/A N/A N/A BIT 11 N/A BIT 10 I Block Present in Data Record BIT 2 N/A BIT 9 T Block Present in Data Record BIT 1 B Block Present in Data Record BIT 8 S Block Present in Data Record BIT 0 A Block Present in Data Record

BIT 7 N/A

BIT 6 N/A

BIT 5 N/A

BIT 4 N/A

BIT 3 N/A

Bytes 2, 3 of Header: Bytes 2 and 3 make a word which represents the Number of bytes in the data record, including the header. Byte 2 is the low byte and byte 3 is the high byte NOTE: The header information of the data records is formatted in little endian.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 4 Communication i 45


General Status Information (1 Byte) BIT 7 Program Running BIT 6 N/A BIT 5 N/A BIT 4 N/A BIT 3 N/A BIT 2 Waiting for input from IN command BIT 1 Trace On BIT 0 Echo On

Axis Switch Information (1 Byte) BIT 7 BIT 6 BIT 5 Latch Occurred State of Latch Input N/A

BIT 4 N/A

BIT 3 State of Forward Limit

BIT 2 State of Reverse Limit

BIT 1 State of Home Input

BIT 0 SM Jumper Installed

Axis Status Information (2 Byte) BIT 15 BIT 14 BIT 13 Move in Progress Mode of Motion PA or PR BIT 7 Negative Direction Move BIT 6 Mode of Motion Contour Mode of Motion PA only

BIT 12 (FE) Find Edge in Progress BIT 4
Motion is stopping due to ST or Limit Switch

BIT 11 Home (HM) in Progress

BIT 10 1st Phase of HM complete

BIT 9
2nd Phase of HM complete or FI command issued

BIT 8 Mode of Motion Coord. Motion BIT 0 Motor Off

BIT 5 Motion is slewing

BIT 3
Motion is making final decel.

BIT 2 Latch is armed

BIT 1 Off-OnError armed

Coordinated Motion Status Information for S or T plane (2 Byte) BIT 15 BIT BIT 13 BIT 12 BIT 11 14 Move in Progress BIT 7 N/A N/A BIT 6 N/A N/A BIT 5 Motion is slewing N/A BIT 4 Motion is stopping due to ST or Limit Switch N/A BIT 3 Motion is making final decel.

BIT 10 N/A BIT 2 N/A

BIT 9 N/A BIT 1 N/A

BIT 8 N/A BIT 0 N/A

Notes Regarding Velocity and Torque Information
The velocity information that is returned in the data record is 64 times larger than the value returned when using the command TV (Tell Velocity). See command reference for more information about TV. The Torque information is represented as a number in the range of +/-32767. Maximum negative torque is -32767. Maximum positive torque is 32767. Zero torque is 0.

46 i Chapter 4 Communication

DMC-14x5/6


QZ Command
The QZ command can be very useful when using the QR command, since it provides information about the controller and the data record. The QZ command returns the following 4 bytes of information. BYTE #
0 1 2 3

INFORMATION
Number of axes present number of bytes in general block of data record number of bytes in coordinate plane block of data record Number of Bytes in each axis block of data record

Controller Response to Commands
Most DMC-14x5 instructions are represented by two characters followed by the appropriate parameters. Each instruction must be terminated by a carriage return or semicolon. Instructions are sent in ASCII, and the DMC-14x5 decodes each ASCII character (one byte) one at a time. It takes approximately 0.5 msec for the controller to decode each command. After the instruction is decoded, the DMC-14x5 returns a response to the port from which the command was generated. If the instruction was valid, the controller returns a colon (:) or a question mark (?) if the instruction was not valid. For example, the controller will respond to commands which are sent via the main RS-232 port back through the RS-232 port, and to commands which are sent via the Ethernet port back through the Ethernet port. For instructions that return data, such as Tell Position (TP), the DMC-14x5 will return the data followed by a carriage return, line feed and : . It is good practice to check for : after each command is sent to prevent errors. An echo function is provided to enable associating the DMC-2x00 response with the data sent. The echo is enabled by sending the command EO 1 to the controller.

Unsolicited Messages Generated by Controller
When the controller is executing a program, it may generate responses which will be sent via the main RS-232 port or Ethernet port. This response could be generated as a result of messages using the MG or IN command OR as a result of a command error. These responses are known as unsolicited messages since they are not generated as the direct response to a command. Messages can be directed to a specific port using the specific Port arguments - see MG and IN commands described in the Command Reference. If the port is not explicitly given, unsolicited messages will be sent to the default port. The default port is determined by the state of the USB/Ethernet dip switch when the system is reset. The controller has a special command, CW, which can affect the format of unsolicited messages. This command is used by Galil Software to differentiate response from the command line and unsolicited messages. The command, CW1 causes the controller to set the high bit of ASCII characters to 1 of all unsolicited characters. This may cause characters to appear garbled to some terminals. This function can be disabled by issuing the command, CW2. For more information, see the CW command in the Command Reference.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 4 Communication i 47


When hardware handshaking is used, characters which are generated by the controller are placed in a single character buffer before they are sent out of the controller. When this buffer becomes full, the controller must either stop executing commands or ignore additional characters generated for output. The command CW,1 causes the controller to ignore all output from the controller while the FIFO is full. The command, CW ,0 causes the controller to stop executing new commands until more room is made available in the FIFO. This command can be very useful when hardware handshaking is being used and the communication line between controller and terminal will be disconnected. In this case, characters will continue to build up in the controller until the FIFO is full. For more information, see the CW command in the Command Reference.

Galil Software Tools and Libraries
API (Application Programming Interface) software is available from Galil. The API software is written in C and is included in the Galil CD-ROM. They can be used for development under Windows environments. With the API's, the user can incorporate already existing library functions directly into a C program. Galil has also developed an Axtive-X Toolkit. This provides 32-bit OCXs for handling all of the DMC-14x5 communications. These objects install directly into Visual Basic and are part of the runtime environment.

48 i Chapter 4 Communication

DMC-14x5/6


Chapter 5 Command Basics

Introduction
The DMC-14XX provides over 100 commands for specifying motion and machine parameters. Commands are included to initiate action, interrogate status and configure the digital filter. These commands can be sent in ASCII or binary. In ASCII, the DMC-14XX instruction set is BASIC-like and easy to use. Instructions consist of two uppercase letters that correspond phonetically with the appropriate function. For example, the instruction BG begins motion, and ST stops the motion. In binary, commands are represented by a binary code ranging from 80 to FF. ASCII commands can be sent "live" over the bus for immediate execution by the DMC-14XX, or an entire group of commands can be downloaded into the DMC-14XX memory for execution at a later time. Combining commands into groups for later execution is referred to as Applications Programming and is discussed in the following chapter. Binary commands cannot be used in Applications programming. This section describes the DMC-14XX instruction set and syntax. A summary of commands as well as a complete listing of all DMC-14XX instructions is included in the Command Reference.

Command Syntax - ASCII
DMC-14XX instructions are represented by two ASCII upper case characters followed by applicable arguments. A space may be inserted between the instruction and arguments. A semicolon or is used to terminate the instruction for processing by the DMC-14XX command interpreter. Note: If you are using a Galil terminal program, commands will not be processed until an command is given. This allows the user to separate many commands on a single line and not begin execution until the user gives the command. IMPORTANT: All DMC-14XX commands are sent in upper case. For example, the command PR 4000 Position relative PR is the two-character instruction for position relative. 4000 is the argument which represents the length of the move in counts. The terminates the instruction. The space between PR and 4000 is optional. When specifying data for the X and Y axes on the DMC-1425, commas are used to separate the axis' parameters. If no data is specified for an axis, a comma is still needed as a place holder - see below. If no data is specified for an axis, the previous value is maintained. The space between the data and instruction is optional.

DMC-14x5/6

TTChapter 5 Command Basics i 49


To view the current values for each command, type the command followed by a ? for each axis requested. This is interrogation. Not all commands can be interrogated. Refer to the Command Reference to determine whether or not a command can be interrogated. PR 1000 PR ,2000 PR 2000, 4000 PR ?,? PR ,? Specify X only as 1000 Specify Y only as 2000 Specify X and Y Request X and Y values Request Y value only

The DMC-14XX provides an alternative method for specifying data. Here data is specified individually using a single axis specifier such as X or Y. An equals sign is used to assign data to that axis. For example:
PRX=1000 ACY=200000 Specify a position relative movement for the X axis of 1000 Specify acceleration for the Y axis as 200000

Instead of data, some commands request action to occur on an axis or group of axes. For example, STXY stops motion on both the X and Y axes. Commas are not required in this case since the particular axis is specified by the appropriate letter X or Y. If no parameters follow the instruction, action will take place on all axes. Here are some examples of syntax for requesting action:
BG X BG Y BG XY BG Begin X only Begin Y only Begin all axes Begin all axes

Coordinated Motion with more than 1 axis
When requesting action for coordinated motion, the letter S is used to specify the coordinated motion. S refers to the coordinate system that can be used on the card. For example:
BG S Begin coordinated sequence on S coordinate system

Command Syntax - Binary
Some commands have an equivalent binary value. Binary communication mode can be executed much faster than ASCII commands. Binary format can only be used when commands are sent from the PC and cannot be embedded in an application program.

50 i TTChapter 5 Command Basics

DMC-14x5/6


Binary Command Format
All binary commands have a 4 byte header and are followed by data fields. The 4 bytes are specified in hexadecimal format. Header Format: Byte 1 specifies the command number between 80 and FF. The complete binary command number table is listed below. Byte 2 specifies the # of bytes in each field as 0,1,2,4 or 6 as follows: 00 01 02 04 06 No datafields (i.e. SH or BG) One byte per field One word (2 bytes per field) One long word (4 bytes) per field Galil real format (4 bytes integer and 2 bytes fraction)

Byte 3 specifies whether the command applies to a coordinated move as follows: 00 01 No coordinated motion movement Coordinated motion movement

For example, the command STS designates motion to stop on a vector motion. The third byte for the equivalent binary command would be 01. Byte 4 specifies the axis # or data field as follows Bit 1 = B axis or 2nd data field Bit 0 = A axis or 1st data field Datafields Format Datafields must be consistent with the format byte and the axes byte. For example, the command PR 1000,500 would be A7 02 00 03 03 E8 FE 0C where A7 is the command number for PR 02 specifies 2 bytes for each data field 00 S is not active for PR 03 specifies bit 0 is active for A axis and bit 1 is active for B axis (20 + 21=3) 03 E8 represents 1000 FE OC represents -500 Example The command ST S would be A1 00 01 where A1 is the command number for ST 00 specifies 0 data fields 01 specifies stop the coordinated axes S

DMC-14x5/6

TTChapter 5 Command Basics i 51


Binary Command Table
Command reserved KP KI KD DV AF KS reserved ER IL TL MT CE OE FL BL AC DC SP IT FA FV GR DP DE OF GM reserved reserved reserved reserved reserved BG ST AB HM FE FI PA PR JG MO SH No. 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 8A 8B 8C 8D 8E 8F 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 9A 9B 9C 9D 9E 9F A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 AA Command reserved reserved reserved reserved reserved LM LI VP CR TN LE, VE VT VA VD VS VR reserved reserved CM CD DT ET EM EP EG EB EQ EC reserved AM MC TW MF MR AD AP AR AS AI AT WT WC reserved No. AB AC AD AE AF B0 B1 B2 A3 B4 B5 B6 B7 B8 B9 BA BB BC BD BE BF C0 C1 C2 C3 C4 C5 C6 C7 C8 C9 CA CB CC CD CE CF D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 Command reserved reserved RP TP TE TD TV RL TT TS TI SC reserved reserved reserved TM CN LZ OP OB SB CB II reserved AL reserved reserved reserved reserved reserved reserved reserved reserved reserved reserved reserved reserved reserved reserved reserved reserved reserved No. D6 D7 D8 D9 DA DB DC DD DE DF E0 E1 E2 E3 E4 E5 E6 E7 E8 E9 EA EB EC ED EE EF F0 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 F6 F7 F8 F9 FA FB FC FD FE FF

52 i TTChapter 5 Command Basics

DMC-14x5/6


Controller Response to DATA
The DMC-14XX returns a : for valid commands. The DMC-14XX returns a ? for invalid commands. For example, if the command BG is sent in lower case, the DMC-14XX will return a ?.
:bg ? invalid command, lower case DMC-14XX returns a ?

When the controller receives an invalid command the user can request the error code. The error code will specify the reason for the invalid command response. To request the error code type the command: TC1 For example:
TC1 1 Unrecognized command Tell Code command Returned response

There are many reasons for receiving an invalid command response. The most common reasons are: unrecognized command (such as typographical entry or lower case), command given at improper time (such as during motion), or a command out of range (such as exceeding maximum speed). A complete listing of all codes can be found in the Command Reference under TC.

Interrogating the Controller
Interrogation Commands
The DMC-14XX has a set of commands that directly interrogate the entered, the requested data is returned in decimal format on the next and line feed. The format of the returned data can be changed using Format (VF) and Leading Zeros (LZ) command. See Chapter 7 and controller. When the command is line followed by a carriage return the Position Format (PF), Variable the Command Reference.

Summary of Interrogation Commands
RP RL


Report Command Position Report Latch


RV

Firmware Revision Information Stop Code Tell Status Tell Error Code Tell Dual Encoder Tell Error Tell Input Tell Position Trace Tell Switches Tell Torque Tell Velocity Tell position X

SC TB TC TD TE TI TP TR TS TT TV TP X

For example, the following example illustrates how to display the current position of the X axis:

DMC-14x5/6

TTChapter 5 Command Basics i 53


0000000000 TP XY 0000000000,0000000000

Controllers Response Tell position X and Y Controllers Response

Interrogating Current Commanded Values.
Most commands can be interrogated by using a question mark (?) as the axis specifier. Type the command followed by a ? for each axis requested.
PR ?,? PR ,? Request X,Y values Request Y value only

The controller can also be interrogated with operands.

Operands
Most DMC-14XX commands have corresponding operands that can be used for interrogation. Operands must be used inside of valid DMC expressions. For example, to display the value of an operand, the user could use the command: MG `operand' where `operand' is a valid DMC operand All of the command operands begin with the underscore character ( _ ). For example, the value of the current position on the X axis can be assigned to the variable `V' with the command: V=_TPX The Command Reference denotes all commands which have an equivalent operand as "Used as an Operand". Also, see description of operands in Chapter 7.

Command Summary
For a complete command summary, see the DMC-1400 Series Command Reference.

54 i TTChapter 5 Command Basics

DMC-14x5/6


Chapter 6 Programming Motion

Overview
The DMC-14XX provides several modes of motion, including independent positioning and jogging, coordinated motion, electronic cam motion, and electronic gearing. Each one of these modes is discussed in the following sections. The DMC-1415 and DMC-1416 are single axis controllers and use X-axis motion only. The DMC1425 is a two axis controller and uses both X and Y. The example applications described below will help guide you to the appropriate mode of motion. In these examples the DMC-1415 and DMC-1416 may perform single moves only, while the DMC-1425 is capable of performing multiple axis moves. Example Application
Absolute or relative positioning where each axis is independent and follows prescribed velocity profile. Velocity control where no final endpoint is prescribed. Motion stops on Stop command. Motion Path described as incremental position points versus time.

Mode of Motion
Independent Axis Positioning

Commands
PA,PR SP,AC,DC JG AC,DC ST CM CD DT WC LM LI,LE VS,VR VA,VD VM VP CR VS,VR VA,VD VE

Independent Jogging

Contour Mode

2 axis coordinated motion where path is described by linear segments.

Linear Interpolation

2-D motion path consisting of arc segments and linear segments, such as engraving or quilting.

Coordinated Motion

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 6 Programming Motion i 55


Third axis must remain tangent to 2-D motion path, such as knife cutting.

Coordinated motion with tangent axis specified

VM VP CR VS,VA,VD TN VE GA GR GM (if gantry) GA GR CM CD DT WC CM CD DT WC RA RD RC DV EA EM EP ET EB EG EQ IT VT KS GR GM

Electronic gearing where slave axes are scaled to master axis which can move in both directions. Master/slave where slave axes must follow a master such as conveyer speed. Moving along arbitrary profiles or mathematically prescribed profiles such as sine or cosine trajectories. Teaching or Record and Play Back

Electronic Gearing

Electronic Gearing Contour Mode

Contour Mode with Automatic Array Capture

Backlash Correction Following a trajectory based on a master encoder position

Dual Loop Electronic Cam

Smooth motion while operating in independent axis Independent Motion Smoothing positioning Smooth motion while operating in vector or linear interpolation positioning Smooth motion while operating with stepper motors Gantry - two axes are coupled by gantry Vector Smoothing Stepper Motor Smoothing Gantry Mode

Independent Axis Positioning
In this mode, motion between the specified axes is independent, and each axis follows its own profile. The user specifies the desired absolute position (PA) or relative position (PR), slew speed (SP), acceleration ramp (AC), and deceleration ramp (DC), for each axis. On begin (BG), the DMC-14XX profiler generates the corresponding trapezoidal or triangular velocity profile and position trajectory. The controller determines a new command position along the trajectory every sample period until the specified profile is complete. Motion is complete when the last position command is sent by the DMC-14XX profiler. Note: The actual motor motion may not be complete when the profile has been completed, however, the next motion command may be specified.

56 i Chapter 6 Programming Motion

DMC-14x5/6


The Begin (BG) command can be issued for all axes either simultaneously or independently. X or Y axis specifiers are required to select the axes for motion. When no axes are specified, this causes motion to begin on all axes. The speed (SP) and the acceleration (AC) can be changed at any time during motion, however, the deceleration (DC) and position (PR or PA) cannot be changed until motion is complete. Remember, motion is complete (AM) when the profiler is finished, not when the actual motor is in position. The Stop command (ST) can be issued at any time to decelerate the motor to a stop before it reaches its final position. An incremental position movement (IP) may be specified during motion as long as the additional move is in the same direction. Here, the user specifies the desired position increment, n. The new target is equal to the old target plus the increment, n. Upon receiving the IP command, a revised profile will be generated for motion towards the new end position. The IP command does not require a begin. Note: If the motor is not moving, the IP command is equivalent to the PR and BG command combination.

Command Summary - Independent Axis
Command
PR x,y PA x,y SP x,y AC x,y DC x,y BG XY ST XY IP x,y IT x,y AM XY MC XY

Description
Specifies relative distance Specifies absolute position Specifies slew speed Specifies acceleration rate Specifies deceleration rate Starts motion Stops motion before end of move Changes position target Time constant for independent motion smoothing Trippoint for profiler complete Trippoint for "in position"

The lower case specifiers (x,y) represent position values for each axis. The DMC-14XX also allows use of single axis specifiers such as PRY=2000

Operand Summary - Independent Axis
Operand
_ACx _DCx _SPx _PAx _PRx PA 10000,20000 AC 1000000,1000000 DC 1000000,1000000 SP 50000,30000 BG XY

Description
Return acceleration rate for the axis specified by `x' Return deceleration rate for the axis specified by `x' Returns the speed for the axis specified by `x' Returns the last command position at which motion stopped Returns current incremental distance specified for the `x' axis Specify absolute X,Y position Acceleration for X,Y Deceleration for X,Y Speeds for X,Y Begin motion

Example - Absolute Position Movement

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 6 Programming Motion i 57


Example - Multiple Move Sequence Required Motion Profiles:
X-Axis 2000 counts 15000 count/sec 500000 counts/sec2 Y-Axis 100 counts 5000 count/sec 500000 counts/sec2 Position Speed Acceleration Position Speed Acceleration

This example will specify a relative position movement on X and Y axes. The movement on each axis will be separated by 40 msec. Fig. 6.1 shows the velocity profiles for the X and Y axes. Instruction Interpretation
#A PR 2000,100 SP 15000,5000 AC 500000,500000 DC 500000,500000 BG X WT 40 BG Y EN Begin Program Specify relative position movement of 2000 and 100 counts for the X and Y axes. Specify speed of 15000 and 5000 counts / sec Specify acceleration of 500000 counts / sec2 for all axes Specify deceleration of 500000 counts / sec2 for all axes Begin motion on the X axis Wait 40 msec Begin motion on the Y axis End Program

VELOCITY (COUNTS/SEC)
X axis velocity profile

20000 15000
Y axis velocity profile

10000 5000 TIME (ms) 0 20 40 60 80 100

Figure 6.1 - Velocity Profiles of XY

Notes on fig 6.1: The X axis has a `trapezoidal' velocity profile, while the Y axis has a `triangular' velocity profile. The X axis accelerates to the specified speed, moves at this constant speed, and then decelerates such that the final position agrees with the commanded position, PR. The Y axis accelerates, but before the specified speed is achieved, must begin deceleration such that the axis will stop at the commanded position. Both axes have the same acceleration and deceleration rate, hence, the slope of the rising and falling edges of both velocity profiles are the same.

58 i Chapter 6 Programming Motion

DMC-14x5/6


Independent Jogging
The jog mode of motion is very flexible because speed, direction and acceleration can be changed during motion. The user specifies the jog speed (JG), acceleration (AC), and the deceleration (DC) rate for each axis. The direction of motion is specified by the sign of the JG parameters. When the begin command is given (BG), the motor accelerates up to speed and continues to jog at that speed until a new speed or stop (ST) command is issued. If the jog speed is changed during motion, the controller will make an accelerated (or decelerated) change to the new speed. An instant change to the motor position can be made with the use of the IP command. Upon receiving this command, the controller commands the motor to a position which is equal to the specified increment plus the current position. This command is useful when trying to synchronize the position of two motors while they are moving. Note that the controller operates as a closed-loop position controller while in the jog mode. The DMC14XX converts the velocity profile into a position trajectory and a new position target is generated every sample period. This method of control results in precise speed regulation with phase lock accuracy.

Command Summary - Jogging
Command
AC x,y BG XY DC x,y IP x,y IT x,y JG +/-x,y ST XY

Description
Specifies acceleration rate Begins motion Specifies deceleration rate Increments position instantly Time constant for independent motion smoothing Specifies jog speed and direction Stops motion

Parameters can be set with individual axis specifiers such as JGY=2000 (set jog speed for Y axis to 2000) or ACXY=400000 (set acceleration for X and Y axes to 400000).

Operand Summary - Independent Axis
Operand
_ACx _DCx _SPx _TVx

Description
Return acceleration rate for the axis specified by `x' Return deceleration rate for the axis specified by `x' Returns the jog speed for the axis specified by `x' Returns the actual velocity of the axis specified by `x' (averaged over .25 sec)

Example - Jog in X only Jog X motor at 50000 count/s. After X motor is at its jog speed, begin jogging Z in reverse direction at 25000 count/s. Instruction Interpretation
#A AC 20000,20000 DC 20000,20000 JG 50000,-25000 Label Specify X,Y acceleration of 20000 cts / sec Specify X,Y deceleration of 20000 cts / sec Specify jog speed and direction for X and Y axis

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 6 Programming Motion i 59


BG X AS X BG Y EN

Begin X motion Wait until X is at speed Begin Y motion

Linear Interpolation Mode
The DMC-14XX provides a linear interpolation mode for 2 axes. In linear interpolation mode, motion between the axes is coordinated to maintain the prescribed vector speed, acceleration, and deceleration along the specified path. The motion path is described in terms of incremental distances for each axis. An unlimited number of incremental segments may be given in a continuous move sequence, making the linear interpolation mode ideal for following a piece-wise linear path. There is no limit to the total move length. The LM command selects the Linear Interpolation mode and axes for interpolation. For example, LM XY selects the X and Y axes for linear interpolation. When using the linear interpolation mode, the LM command only needs to be specified once unless the axes for linear interpolation change.

Specifying Linear Segments
The command LI x,y specifies the incremental move distance for each axis. This means motion is prescribed with respect to the current axis position. Up to 255 incremental move segments may be given prior to the Begin Sequence (BGS or BGT) command. Once motion has begun, additional LI segments may be sent to the controller. The clear sequence (CS) command can be used to remove LI segments stored in the buffer prior to the start of the motion. To stop the motion, use the instructions STS, STT, or AB. The command, ST, causes a decelerated stop. The command, AB, causes an instantaneous stop and aborts the program, and the command AB1 aborts the motion only. The Linear End (LE) command must be used to specify the end of a linear move sequence. This command tells the controller to decelerate to a stop following the last LI command. If an LE command is not given, an Abort AB1 must be used to abort the motion sequence. It is the responsibility of the user to keep enough LI segments in the DMC-14XX sequence buffer to ensure continuous motion. If the controller receives no additional LI segments and no LE command, the controller will stop motion instantly at the last vector. There will be no controlled deceleration. LM? or _LM returns the available spaces for LI segments that can be sent to the buffer. 255 returned means the buffer is empty and 255 LI segments can be sent. A zero means the buffer is full and no additional segments can be sent. As long as the buffer is not full, additional LI segments can be sent at PC bus speeds. The instruction _CS returns the number of the segment being processed. As the segments are processed, _CS increases, starting at zero. This function allows the host computer to determine which segment is being completed. Additional Commands The commands VS n, VA n, and VD n are used to specify the vector speed, acceleration, and deceleration. The DMC-14XX computes the vector speed based on the axes specified in the LM mode. For example, LM XY designates linear interpolation for the X and Y axes. The vector speed for this example would be computed using the equation: 2 2 2 VS =XS +YS , where XS and YS are the speed of the X and Y axes. The controller computes the vector speed with the axis specifications from LM.

60 i Chapter 6 Programming Motion

DMC-14x5/6


VT is used to set the smoothing constant for coordinated moves. The command AV n is the `After Vector' trippoint, which halts program execution until the vector distance of n has been reached. An Example of Linear Interpolation Motion: Instruction Interpretation
#LMOVE DP 0,0 LMXY LI 5000,0 LI 0,5000 LE VS 4000 BGS AV 4000 VS 1000 AV 5000 VS 4000 EN Label Define position of X and Y axes to be 0 Define linear mode between X and Y axes. Specify first linear segment Specify second linear segment End linear segments Specify vector speed Begin motion sequence Set trippoint to wait until vector distance of 4000 is reached Change vector speed Set trippoint to wait until vector distance of 5000 is reached Change vector speed Program end

In this example, the XY system is required to perform a 90° turn. In order to slow the speed around the corner, we use the AV 4000 trippoint, which slows the speed to 1000 count/s. Once the motors reach the corner, the speed is increased back to 4000 cts / s. Specifying Vector Speed for Each Segment The instruction VS has an immediate effect and, therefore, must be given at the required time. In some applications, such as CNC, it is necessary to attach various speeds to different motion segments. This can be done with two functions: < n and > m For example: LI x,y < n >m The first command, < n, is equivalent to commanding VSn at the start of the given segment and will cause an acceleration toward the new commanded speed, subject to the other constraints. The second function, > m, requires the vector speed to reach the value m at the end of the segment. Note that the function > m may start the deceleration within the given segment or during previous segments, as needed to meet the final speed requirement, under the given values of VA and VD. Note, however, that the controller works with one > m command at a time. As a consequence, one function may be masked by another. For example, if the function >100000 is followed by >5000, and the distance for deceleration is not sufficient, the second condition will not be met. The controller will attempt to lower the speed to 5000. As an example, consider the following program. Instruction Interpretation
#ALT DP 0,0 LMXY LI 4000,0 <4000 >1000 LI 1000,1000 < 4000 >1000 LI 0,5000 < 4000 >1000 LE BGS EN Label for alternative program Define Position of X and Y axis to be 0 Define linear mode between X and Y axes. Specify first linear segment with a vector speed of 4000 and end speed 1000 Specify second linear segment with a vector speed of 4000 and end speed 1000 Specify third linear segment with a vector speed of 4000 and end speed 1000 End linear segments Begin motion sequence Program end

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 6 Programming Motion i 61


Changing Feedrate: The command VR n allows the feedrate, VS, to be scaled between 0 and 10 with a resolution of .0001. This command takes effect immediately and causes VS to be scaled. VR also applies when the vector speed is specified with the `<' operator. This is a useful feature for feedrate override. VR does not ratio the accelerations. For example, VR .5 results in the specification VS 2000 to be divided in half.

Command Summary - Linear Interpolation
Command
LM xy LM? LI x,y < n VS n VA n VD n VR n BGS CS LE LE? AMS or AMT AV n VT

Description
Specify axes for linear interpolation Returns number of available spaces for linear segments in DMC-14XX sequence buffer. Zero means buffer full. 255 means buffer empty. Specify incremental distances relative to current position, and assign vector speed n. Specify vector speed Specify vector acceleration Specify vector deceleration Specify the vector speed ratio Begin Linear Sequence (on S coordinate system) Clear sequence Linear End- Required at end of LI command sequence Returns the length of the vector (resets after 2147483647) Trippoint for After Sequence complete (on S or T coordinate system) Trippoint for After Relative Vector distance, n Motion smoothing constant for vector moves

Operand Summary - Linear Interpolation
Operand
_AV _CS _LE _LM _VPx

Description
Return distance traveled Segment counter - returns number of the segment in the sequence being processed, starting at zero. Returns length of vector (resets after 2147483647) Returns number of available spaces for linear segments in DMC-14XX sequence buffer. Zero means buffer full. 255 means buffer empty. Return the absolute coordinate of the last data point along the trajectory. (x=X,Y,Z or W)

To illustrate the ability to interrogate the motion status, consider the first motion segment of our example, #LMOVE, where the X axis moves toward the point X=5000. Suppose that when X=3000, the controller is interrogated using the command `MG _AV'. The returned value will be 3000. The value of _CS, _VPX and _VPY will be zero. Now suppose that the interrogation is repeated at the second segment when Y=2000. The value of _AV at this point is 7000, _CS equals 1, _VPX=5000 and _VPY=0.

62 i Chapter 6 Programming Motion

DMC-14x5/6


Example - Linear Move
Make a coordinated linear move in the XY plane. Move to coordinates 40000,30000 counts at a vector speed of 100000 counts/sec and vector acceleration of 1000000 counts/sec2. Instruction
LM XY LI40000,30000 LE VS 100000 VA 1000000 VD 1000000 BGS

Interpretation
Specify axes for linear interpolation Specify XY distances Specify end move Specify vector speed Specify vector acceleration Specify vector deceleration Begin sequence

Note that the above program specifies the vector speed, VS, and not the actual axis speeds VX and VY the axis speeds are determined by the DMC-14XX from:

VS = VX 2 + VY

2

The resulting profile is shown in Figure 6.2.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 6 Programming Motion i 63


30000 27000

POSITION Y

3000 0 0 4000 POSITION X 36000 40000

FEEDRATE

0 VELOCITY X-AXIS

0.1

0.5

0.6

TIME (sec)

TIME (sec)

VELOCITY Y-AXIS

TIME (sec)
Figure 6.2 - Linear Interpolation

64 i Chapter 6 Programming Motion

DMC-14x5/6


Example - Multiple Moves
This example makes a coordinated linear move in the XY plane. The Arrays VX and VY are used to store 750 incremental distances which are filled by the program #LOAD. Instruction Interpretation
#LOAD DM VX [750],VY [750] COUNT=0 N=10 #LOOP VX [COUNT]=N VY [COUNT]=N N=N+10 COUNT=COUNT+1 JP #LOOP,COUNT<750 #A LM XY COUNT=0 #LOOP2;JP#LOOP2,_LM=0 JS#C,COUNT=250 LI VX[COUNT],VY[COUNT] COUNT=COUNT+1 JP #LOOP2,COUNT<750 LE AMS MG "DONE" EN #C;BGS;EN Load Program Define Array Initialize Counter Initialize position increment LOOP Fill Array VX Fill Array VY Increment position Increment counter Loop if array not full Label Specify linear mode for XY Initialize array counter If sequence buffer full, wait Begin motion on 250th segment Specify linear segment Increment array counter Repeat until array done End Linear Move After Move sequence done Send Message End program Begin Motion Subroutine

Vector Mode: Linear and Circular Interpolation Motion
The DMC-14XX allows a long 2-D path consisting of linear and arc segments to be prescribed. Motion along the path is continuous at the chosen vector speed even at transitions between linear and circular segments. The DMC-14XX performs all the complex computations of linear and circular interpolation, freeing the host PC from this time intensive task. The coordinated motion mode is similar to the linear interpolation mode. Any pair of two axes may be selected for coordinated motion consisting of linear and circular segments. Note that only one pair of axes can be specified for coordinated motion at any given time.

Specifying Vector Segments
The motion segments are described by two commands; VP for linear segments and CR for circular segments. Once a set of linear segments and/or circular segments have been specified, the sequence is ended with the command VE. This defines a sequence of commands for coordinated motion. Immediately prior to the execution of the first coordinated movement, the controller defines the current

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 6 Programming Motion i 65


position to be zero for all movements in a sequence. Note: This `local' definition of zero does not affect the absolute coordinate system or subsequent coordinated motion sequences. The command, VP x,y specifies the coordinates of the end points of the vector movement with respect to the starting point. The command, CR r,, define a circular arc with a radius r, starting angle of , and a traversed angle . The notation for is that zero corresponds to the positive horizontal direction, and for both and , the counter-clockwise (CCW) rotation is positive. Up to 255 segments of CR or VP may be specified in a single sequence and must be ended with the command VE. The motion can be initiated with a Begin Sequence (BGS or BGT) command. Once motion starts, additional segments may be added. The Clear Sequence (CS) command can be used to remove previous VP and CR commands which were stored in the buffer prior to the start of the motion. To stop the motion, use the instructions STS or AB1. ST stops motion at the specified deceleration. AB1 aborts the motion instantaneously. The Vector End (VE) command must be used to specify the end of the coordinated motion. This command tells the controller to decelerate to a stop following the last motion in the sequence. If a VE command is not given, an Abort (AB1) must be used to abort the coordinated motion sequence. The user must keep enough motion segments in the DMC-14XX sequence buffer to ensure continuous motion. If the controller receives no additional motion segments and no VE command, the controller will stop motion instantly at the last vector. There will be no controlled deceleration. LM? or _LM returns the available spaces for motion segments that can be sent to the buffer. 255 returned means the buffer is empty and 255 segments can be sent. A zero means the buffer is full and no additional segments can be sent. As long as the buffer is not full, additional segments can be sent at the PCI bus speed. The operand _CS can be used to determine the value of the segment counter.

Additional commands
The commands VS n, VA n and VD n are used for specifying the vector speed, acceleration, and deceleration. VT is the motion smoothing constant used for coordinated motion. Specifying Vector Speed for Each Segment: The vector speed may be specified by the immediate command VS. It can also be attached to a motion segment with the instructions VP x,y < n >m CR r,, < n >m The first parameter, m, requires the vector speed to reach the value m at the end of the segment. Note that the function > m may start the deceleration within the given segment or during previous segments, as needed to meet the final speed requirement, under the given values of VA and VD. Note, however, that the controller works with one > m command at a time. As a consequence, one function may be masked by another. For example, if the function >100000 is followed by >5000, and the distance for deceleration is not sufficient, the second condition will not be met. The controller will attempt to lower the speed to 5000, but will reach that at a different point. Changing Feedrate: The command VR n allows the feedrate, VS, to be scaled from 0 and 10 times with a resolution of .0001. This command takes effect immediately and causes VS scaled. VR also applies when the

66 i Chapter 6 Programming Motion

DMC-14x5/6


vector speed is specified with the `<' operator. This is a useful feature for feedrate override. VR does not ratio the accelerations. For example, VR .5 results in the specification VS 2000 act as VS 1000. Compensating for Differences in Encoder Resolution: By default, the DMC-14XX uses a scale factor of 1:1 for the encoder resolution when used in vector mode. If this is not the case, the command, ES can be used to scale the encoder counts. The ES command accepts two arguments which represent the ratio of the encoder resolutions. For more information refer to ES in the Command Reference. Trippoints: The AV n command is the After Vector trippoint, which waits for the vector relative distance of n to occur before executing the next command in a program.

Command Summary - Coordinated Motion Sequence
Command
VM m,n VP m,n CR r,, VS n VA n VD n VR n BGS CS AV n AMS ES m,n VT LM?

Description
Specifies the axes for the planar motion where m and n represent the planar axes. Return coordinate of last point, where m=X,Y,Z or W. Specifies arc segment where r is the radius, is the starting angle and is the travel angle. Positive direction is CCW. Specify vector speed or feedrate of sequence. Specify vector acceleration along the sequence. Specify vector deceleration along the sequence. Specify vector speed ratio Begin motion sequence on S coordinate system. Clear sequence. Trippoint for After Relative Vector distance, n. Holds execution of next command until Motion Sequence is complete. Ellipse scale factor. Smoothing constant for coordinated moves Return number of available spaces for linear and circular segments in DMC-14XX sequence buffer. Zero means buffer is full. 255 means buffer is empty.

Operand Summary - Coordinated Motion Sequence
Operand
_VPM _AV _LM _CS _VE

Description
The absolute coordinate of the axes at the last intersection along the sequence. Distance traveled. Number of available spaces for linear and circular segments in DMC-14XX sequence buffer. Zero means buffer is full. 255 means buffer is empty. Segment counter - Number of the segment in the sequence, starting at zero. Vector length of coordinated move sequence.

When AV is used as an operand, _AV returns the distance traveled along the sequence. The operands _VPX and _VPY can be used to return the coordinates of the last point specified along the path.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 6 Programming Motion i 67


Example: Traverse the path shown in Fig. 6.3. Feedrate is 20000 counts/sec. Plane of motion is XY Instruction Interpretation
VM XY VS 20000 VA 1000000 VD 1000000 VP -4000,0 CR 1500,270,-180 VP 0,3000 CR 1500,90,-180 VE BGS Specify motion plane Specify vector speed Specify vector acceleration Specify vector deceleration Segment AB Segment BC Segment CD Segment DA End of sequence Begin Sequence

The resulting motion starts at the point A and moves toward points B, C, D, A. Suppose that we interrogate the controller when the motion is halfway between the points A and B. The value of _AV is 2000 The value of _CS is 0 _VPX and _VPY contain the absolute coordinate of the point A Suppose that the interrogation is repeated at a point, halfway between the points C and D. The value of _AV is 4000+1500+2000=10,712 The value of _CS is 2 _VPX,_VPY contain the coordinates of the point C

C (-4000,3000)

D (0,3000)

R = 1500

B (-4000,0)
Figure 6.3 - The Required Path

A (0,0)

Electronic Gearing
This mode allows multiple axes to be electronically geared to some master axes. With the DMC-1415 or DMC-1416, the master is always the auxiliary encoder. With the DMC-1425, the master will be the

68 i Chapter 6 Programming Motion

DMC-14x5/6


X or Y axis. The masters may rotate in both directions and the geared axes will follow at the specified gear ratio. The gear ratio may be different for each axis and changed during motion. The command GA specifies the master axes for the DMC-1425. The GA command is unnecessary for the DMC-1415 or DMC-1416, as the auxiliary encoder is automatically used. GR x,y specifies the gear ratios for the slaves where the ratio may be a number between +/-127.9999 with a fractional resolution of .0001. There are two modes: standard gearing and gantry mode. The gantry mode is enabled with the command GM. GR 0,0 turns off gearing in both modes. A limit switch or ST command disables gearing in the standard mode but not in the gantry mode. The command GM x,y selects the axes to be controlled under the gantry mode. The parameter 1 enables gantry mode, and 0 disables it. GR causes the specified axes to be geared to the actual position of the master. The master axis is commanded with motion commands such as PR, PA, or JG. When the master axis is driven by the controller in the jog mode or an independent motion mode, it is possible to define the master as the command position of that axis, rather than the actual position. The designation of the commanded position master is by the letter C. For example, GA, CX indicates that the gearing is the commanded position of X. Electronic gearing allows the geared motor to perform a second independent or coordinated move in addition to the gearing. For example, when a geared motor follows a master at a ratio of 1:1, it may be advanced an additional distance with PR, JG, VP, or LI commands.

Command Summary - Electronic Gearing
Command
GA n

Description
Specifies master axes for gearing where: N = X,Y or A,B for main encoder as master N = CX,CY or CA, CB for commanded position. Sets gear ratio for slave axes. 0 disables electronic gearing for specified axis. Sets gear ratio for slave axes. 0 disables electronic gearing for specified axis. X = 1 sets gantry mode, 0 disables gantry mode Trippoint for reverse motion past specified value. Only one field may be used. Trippoint for forward motion past specified value. Only one field may be used.

GR x,y GR a,b GM a,b MR x,y MF x,y

Example - Electronic Gearing DMC-1415 or DMC-1416 Objective: Run a geared motor at a speed of 1.132 times the speed of an external master. The master is driven at speeds between 0 and 1800 RPM (2000 counts/rev encoder), and is connected through the auxiliary encoder inputs. Solution: Use a DMC-1415 controller, where the X-axis auxiliary is the master and X-axis main is the geared axis.
GR 1.132 Specify gear ratio

Now suppose the gear ratio of the X-axis is to change on-the-fly to 2. This can be achieved by commanding:
GR 2 Specify gear ratio for X axis to be 2

Example ­ Electronic Gearing DMC-1425 Objective: Gear an X-axis slave motor at a speed of 2.5 times the speed of the Y-axis master.
GAY GR2.5 Specify Y-axis as the master for X Specify gear ratio for X to be 2.5 times the Y axis master.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 6 Programming Motion i 69


Example - Gantry Mode In applications where both the master and the follower are controlled by the DMC-1425 controller, it may be desired to synchronize the follower with the commanded position of the master, rather than the actual position. This eliminates the possibility of an oscillation on the master passing the oscillation on to the slave. For example, assume that a gantry is driven by two axes, X and Y, one on each side. This requires the gantry mode for strong coupling between the motors. The X-axis is the master and the Y-axis is the follower. To synchronize Y with the commanded position of X, use the instructions:
GA, CX GR,1 GM,1 PR 3000 BG X Specify the commanded position of X as master for Y. Set gear ratio for Y as 1:1 Set gantry mode Command X motion Start motion on X axis

You may also perform profiled position corrections in the electronic gearing mode. Suppose, for example, that you need to advance the slave 10 counts. Simply command
IP ,10 PR,10 BGY Specify an incremental position movement of 10 on the Y axis. Specify position relative movement of 10 on the Y axis Begin motion on the Y axis

Under these conditions, this IP command is equivalent to:

Often the correction is quite large. Such requirements are common when synchronizing cutting knives or conveyor belts. Example - Synchronize two conveyor belts with trapezoidal velocity correction. Instruction
GA,X GR,2 PR,300 SP,5000 AC,100000 DC,100000 BGY

Interpretation
Define X as the master axis for Y. Set gear ratio 2:1 for Y Specify correction distance Specify correction speed Specify correction acceleration Specify correction deceleration Start correction

Electronic Cam
The electronic cam is a motion control mode which enables the periodic synchronization of several axes of motion. Similar to the gearing mode, the DMC-1425 uses only X and Y main axes as the master or slave, while the DMC-1415 and DMC-1416 use the auxiliary encoder as the master axis. The electronic cam is a more general type of electronic gearing which allows a table-based relationship between the axes. It allows synchronizing all the controller axes. To illustrate the procedure of setting the cam mode, consider the cam relationship shown in Figure 6.4. Step 1. Selecting the master axis. (DMC-1425 only) The first step in the electronic cam mode is to select the master axis. This is done with the instruction EAp where p = X,Y p is the selected master axis

70 i Chapter 6 Programming Motion

DMC-14x5/6


In this example x axis will be the master. Thus we specify EAX Step 2. Specify the master cycle and the change in the slave axes. In the electronic cam mode, the position of the master is always expressed within one cycle. In this example, the position of x is always expressed in the range between 0 and 6000. Similarly, the slave position is also redefined such that it starts at zero and ends at 1500. At the end of a cycle when the master is 6000 and the slave is 1500, the positions of both x and y are redefined as zero. To specify the master cycle and the slave cycle change, we use the instruction EM. EM x,y where x,y specify the cycle of the master and the total change of the slaves over one cycle. On the DMC-1415 and DMC-1416, x will always be the slave cycle, and y will be the master cycle The cycle of the master is limited to 8,388,607 whereas the slave change per cycle is limited to 2,147,483,647. If the change is a negative number, the absolute value is specified. For the given example, the cycle of the master is 6000 counts and the change in the slave is 1500. Therefore, we use the instruction: EM 6000,1500 (DMC-1425) EM 1500,6000 (DMC-1415/1416) Step 3. Specify the master interval and starting point. Next we need to construct the ECAM table. The table is specified at uniform intervals of master positions. Up to 256 intervals are allowed. The size of the master interval and the starting point are specified by the instruction: EP m,n where m is the interval width in counts, and n is the starting point. For the given example, we can specify the table by specifying the position at the master points of 0, 2000, 4000 and 6000. We can specify that by EP 2000,0 Step 4. Specify the slave positions. Next, we specify the slave positions with the instruction ET[n]=x,y (DMC-1425) ET[n]=x (DMC-1415/1416)

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 6 Programming Motion i 71


where n indicates the order of the point. The value, n, starts at zero and may go up to 256. The parameters x,y indicate the corresponding slave position. For this example, the table may be specified by ET[0]=0 ET[1]=,3000 ET[2]=,2250 ET[3]=,1500 This specifies the ECAM table. Step 5. Enable the ECAM To enable the ECAM mode, use the command EB n where n=1 enables ECAM mode and n=0 disables ECAM mode. Step 6. Engage the slave motion To engage the slave motion, use the instruction EG x,y where x,y are the master positions at which the corresponding slaves must be engaged. If the value of any parameter is outside the range of one cycle, the cam engages immediately. When the cam is engaged, the slave position is redefined, modulo one cycle. Step 7. Disengage the slave motion To disengage the cam, use the command EQ x,y where x,y are the master positions at which the corresponding slave axes are disengaged. DMC-1425 ET[0]=0 ET[1]=3000 ET[2]=2250 ET[3]=1500 DMC-1415/1416

72 i Chapter 6 Programming Motion

DMC-14x5/6


3000 2250 1500

0

2000

4000

6000

Master X

Figure 6.4 - Electronic Cam Example

This disengages the slave axis at a specified master position. If the parameter is outside the master cycle, the stopping is instantaneous. To illustrate the complete process, consider the cam relationship described by the equation: Y = 0.5 * X + 100 sin (0.18*X) where X is the master, with a cycle of 2000 counts. The cam table can be constructed manually, point by point, or automatically by a program. The following program includes the set-up. The instruction EAX defines X as the master axis. The cycle of the master is 2000. Over that cycle, Y varies by 1000. This leads to the instruction EM 2000,1000. Suppose we want to define a table with 100 segments. This implies increments of 20 counts each. If the master points are to start at zero, the required instruction is EP 20,0. The following routine computes the table points. As the phase equals 0.18X and X varies in increments of 20, the phase varies by increments of 3.6°. The program then computes the values of Y according to the equation and assigns the values to the table with the instruction ET[N] = ,Y. Instruction
#SETUP EAX EM 2000,1000

Interpretation
Label Select X as master Cam cycles

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 6 Programming Motion i 73


EP 20,0 N=0 #LOOP P = N3.6 S = @SIN [P] *100 Y = N *10+S ET [N] =, Y N = N+1 JP #LOOP, N<=100 EN

Master position increments Index Loop to construct table from equation Note 3.6 = 0.1820 Define sine position Define slave position Define table Repeat the process

Now suppose that the slave axis is engaged with a start signal, input 1, but that both the engagement and disengagement points must be done at the center of the cycle: X = 1000 and Y = 500. This implies that Y must be driven to that point to avoid a jump. This is done with the program: Instruction Interpretation
#RUN EB1 PA,500 SP,5000 BGY AM AI1 EG,1000 AI ­ 1 EQ,1000 EN Label Enable cam Y starting position Y speed Move Y motor After Y moved Wait for start signal Engage slave Wait for stop signal Disengage slave End

The following example illustrates a cam program with a master axis, X, and a single slave Y. Instruction
#A;V1=0 PA 0,0;BGXY;AMXY EA X EM 4000,0 EP400,0 ET[0]=,0 ET[1]=,20 ET[2]=,60 ET[3]=,120 ET[4]=,140 ET[5]=,140 ET[6]=,140

Interpretation
Label; Initialize variable Go to position 0,0 on X and Y axes Z axis as the Master for ECAM Change for X is 4000, zero for Y ECAM interval is 400 counts with zero start When master is at 0 position; 1st point. 2nd point in the ECAM table 3rd point in the ECAM table 4th point in the ECAM table 5th point in the ECAM table 6th point in the ECAM table 7th point in the ECAM table

74 i Chapter 6 Programming Motion

DMC-14x5/6


ET[7]=,120 ET[8]=,60 ET[9]=,20 ET[10]=,0 EB 1 JGX=4000 EG ,0 BGX #LOOP;JP#LOOP,V1=0 EQ,2000 MF2000 ST X EB 0 EN

8th point in the ECAM table 9th point in the ECAM table 10th point in the ECAM table Starting point for next cycle Enable ECAM mode Set Z to jog at 4000 Engage both X and Y when Master = 0 Begin jog on Z axis Loop until the variable is set Disengage Y when Master = 2000 Wait until the Master goes to 2000 Stop the Z axis motion Exit the ECAM mode End of the program

Contour Mode
The DMC-14XX also provides a contouring mode. This mode allows any arbitrary position curve to be prescribed for any motion axes. This is ideal for following computer generated paths such as parabolic, spherical or user-defined profiles. The path is not limited to straight line and arc segments and the path length may be infinite.

Specifying Contour Segments
The Contour Mode is specified with the command, CM. For example, CMXY specifies contouring on the X and Y axes. Any axes that are not being used in the contouring mode may be operated in other modes. A contour is described by position increments which are described with the command, CD x,y over a n time interval, DT n. The parameter, n, specifies the time interval. The time interval is defined as 2 ms, where n is a number between 1 and 8. The controller performs linear interpolation between the specified increments, where one point is generated for each millisecond. Consider, for example, the trajectory shown in Fig. 6.5. The position X may be described by the points:
Point 1 Point 2 Point 3 Point 4 X=0 at T=0ms X=48 at T=4ms X=288 at T=12ms X=336 at T=28ms

The same trajectory may be represented by the increments
Increment 1 Increment 2 Increment 3 DX=48 DX=240 DX=48 Time Increment =4 Time Increment =8 Time Increment =16 DT=2 DT=3 DT=4

When the controller receives the command to generate a trajectory along these points, it interpolates linearly between the points. The resulting interpolated points include the position 12 at 1 msec, position 24 at 2 msec, etc.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 6 Programming Motion i 75


The programmed commands to specify the above example are: Instruction
#A CMX DT 2 CD 48;WC DT 3 CD 240;WC DT 4 CD 48;WC DT0;CD0 EN

Description
Label Specifies X axis for contour mode Specifies first time interval, 22 ms Specifies first position increment Specifies second time interval, 23 ms Specifies second position increment Specifies the third time interval, 24 ms Specifies the third position increment Exits contour mode

POSITION (COUNTS)

336 288 240 192 96 48 0 4 8
SEGMENT 2

TIME (ms) 12 16 20
SEGMENT 3

24

28

SEGMENT 1

Figure 6.5 - The Required Trajectory

Additional Commands
The command, WC, is used as a trippoint "When Complete" or "Wait for Contour Data". This allows the DMC-14XX to use the next increment only when it is finished with the previous one. Zero parameters for DT followed by zero parameters for CD exit the contour mode. If no new data record is found and the controller is still in the contour mode, the controller waits for new data. No new motion commands are generated while waiting. If bad data is received, the controller responds with a ?.

Command Summary - Contour Mode
Command Description

76 i Chapter 6 Programming Motion

DMC-14x5/6


CM XY CD x,y DT n

Specifies which axes for contouring mode. Any non-contouring axes may be operated in other modes. Specifies position increment over time interval. Range is +/-32,000. Zero ends contour mode. Specifies time interval 2n msec for position increment, where n is an integer between 1 and 8. Zero ends contour mode. If n does not change, it does not need to be specified with each CD. Waits for previous time interval to be complete before next data record is processed.

WC

Operand Summary - Contour Mode
Operand
_CS

Description
Return segment number

General Velocity Profiles The Contour Mode is ideal for generating an arbitrary velocity profile. The velocity profile can be specified as a mathematical function or as a collection of points. The design includes two parts: Generating an array with data points and running the program. Generating an Array - An Example Consider the velocity and position profiles shown in Fig. 6.6. The objective is to rotate a motor a distance of 6000 counts in 120 ms. The velocity profile is sinusoidal to reduce the jerk and the system vibration. If we describe the position displacement in terms of A counts in B milliseconds, we can describe the motion in the following manner: = (A/B) [1 - cos (2/B)] X = (AT/B) - (A/2)sin (2/B) Note: is the angular velocity; X is the position; and T is the variable, time, in milliseconds. In the given example, A=6000 and B=120, the position and velocity profiles are: X = 50T - (6000/2) sin (2 T/120) Note that the velocity, , in count/ms, is = 50 [1 - cos 2 T/120]

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 6 Programming Motion i 77


ACCELERATION

VELOCITY

POSITION
Figure 6.6 - Velocity Profile with Sinusoidal Acceleration

The DMC-14XX can compute trigonometric functions. However, the argument must be expressed in degrees. Using our example, the equation for X is written as: X = 50T - 955 sin 3T A complete program to generate the contour movement in this example is given below. To generate an array, we compute the position value at intervals of 8 ms. This is stored at the array POS. Then, the difference between the positions is computed and is stored in the array DIF. Finally the motors are run in the contour mode.

78 i Chapter 6 Programming Motion

DMC-14x5/6


Contour Mode Example Instruction
#POINTS DM POS[16] DM DIF[15] C=0 T=0 #A V1=50*T V2=3*T V3=-955*@SIN[V2]+V1 V4=@INT[V3] POS[C]=V4 T=T+8 C=C+1 JP #A,C<16 #B C=0 #C D=C+1 DIF[C]=POS[D]-POS[C] C=C+1 JP #C,C<15 EN #RUN CMX DT3 C=0 #E CD DIF[C] WC C=C+1 JP #E,C<15 DT0 CD0 EN

Interpretation
Program defines X points Allocate memory Set initial conditions, C is index T is time in ms

Argument in degrees Compute position Integer value of V3 Store in array POS

Program to find position differences

Compute the difference and store

End first program Program to run motor Contour Mode 4 millisecond intervals

Contour Distance is in DIF Wait for completion

Stop Contour End the program

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 6 Programming Motion i 79


Teach (Record and Play-Back) Several applications require teaching the machine a motion trajectory. Teaching can be accomplished using the DMC-14XX automatic array capture feature to capture position data. The captured data may then be played back in the contour mode. The following array commands are used:
DM C[n] RA C[] RD _TPX RC n,m RC? or _RC Dimension array Specify array for automatic record (up to 4) Specify data for capturing (such as _TPX or _TPY) Specify capture time interval where n is 2n msec, m is number of records to be captured Returns a 1 if recording

Record and Playback Example: Instruction Interpretation
#RECORD DM XPOS[501] RA XPOS[] RD _TPX MOX RC2 #A;JP#A,_RC=1 #COMPUTE DM DX[500] C=0 #L D=C+1 DELTA=XPOS[D]-XPOS[C] Compute the difference DX[C]=DELTA C=C+1 JP #L,C<500 #PLAYBCK CMX DT2 I=0 #B CD XPOS[I];WC DT 0;CD0 EN Store difference in array Increment index Repeat until done Begin Playback Specify contour mode Specify time increment Initialize array counter Loop counter Specify contour data I=I+1 Increment array counter JP #B,I<500 Loop until done End contour mode End program Begin Program Dimension array with 501 elements Specify automatic record Specify X position to be captured Turn X motor off Begin recording; 4 msec interval Continue until done recording Compute DX Dimension Array for DX Initialize counter Label

For additional information about automatic array capture, see Chapter 7, Arrays.

Stepper Motor Operation
When configured for stepper motor operation, several commands are interpreted differently than from servo mode. The following describes operation with stepper motors.

80 i Chapter 6 Programming Motion

DMC-14x5/6


Specifying Stepper Motor Operation
In order to command stepper motor operation, the appropriate stepper mode jumpers must be installed. See chapter 2 for this installation. Stepper motor operation is specified by the command MT. The argument for MT is as follows: 2 specifies a stepper motor with active low step output pulses -2 specifies a stepper motor with active high step output pulses 2.5 specifies a stepper motor with active low step output pulses and reversed direction -2.5 specifies a stepper motor with active high step output pulse and reversed direction Stepper Motor Smoothing The command, KS, provides stepper motor smoothing. The effect of the smoothing can be thought of as a simple Resistor-Capacitor (single pole) filter. The filter occurs after the motion profiler and has the effect of smoothing out the spacing of pulses for a more smooth operation of the stepper motor. Use of KS is most applicable when operating in full step or half step operation. KS will cause the step pulses to be delayed in accordance with the time constant specified. When operating with stepper motors, you will always have some amount of stepper motor smoothing, KS. Since this filtering effect occurs after the profiler, the profiler may be ready for additional moves before all of the step pulses have gone through the filter. It is important to consider this effect since steps may be lost if the controller is commanded to generate an additional move before the previous move has been completed. See the discussion below, Monitoring Generated Pulses vs. Commanded Pulses. The general motion smoothing command, IT, can also be used. The purpose of the command, IT, is to smooth out the motion profile and decrease 'jerk' due to acceleration. Monitoring Generated Pulses vs. Commanded Pulses For proper controller operation, it is necessary to make sure that the controller has completed generating all step pulses before making additional moves. This is most particularly important if you are moving back and forth. For example, when operating with servo motors, the trippoint AM (After Motion) is used to determine when the motion profiler is complete and is prepared to execute a new motion command. However when operating in stepper mode, the controller may still be generating step pulses when the motion profiler is complete. This is caused by the stepper motor smoothing filter, KS. To understand this, consider the steps the controller executes to generate step pulses: First, the controller generates a motion profile in accordance with the motion commands. Second, the profiler generates pulses as prescribed by the motion profile. The pulses that are generated by the motion profiler can be monitored by the command, RP (Reference Position). RP gives the absolute value of the position as determined by the motion profiler. The command, DP, can be used to set the value of the reference position. For example, DP 0, defines the reference position of the X axis to be zero. Third, the output of the motion profiler is filtered by the stepper smoothing filter. This filter adds a delay in the output of the stepper motor pulses. The amount of delay depends on the parameter which is specified by the command, KS. As mentioned earlier, there will always be some amount of stepper motor smoothing. The default value for KS is 2 which corresponds to a time constant of 6 sample periods. Fourth, the output of the stepper smoothing filter is buffered and is available for input to the stepper motor driver. The pulses which are generated by the smoothing filter can be monitored by the command, TD (Tell Dual). TD gives the absolute value of the position as determined by actual output of the buffer. The command, DP sets the value of the step count register as well as the value of the reference position. For example, DP 0, defines the reference position of the X axis to be zero.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 6 Programming Motion i 81


Motion Profiler

Stepper Smoothing Filter (Adds a Delay)

Output Buffer

Output (To Stepper Driver)

Reference Position (RP)

Step Count Register (TD)

Motion Complete Trippoint When used in stepper mode, the MC command will hold up execution of the proceeding commands until the controller has generated the same number of steps out of the step count register as specified in the commanded position. The MC trippoint (Motion Complete) is generally more useful than the AM trippoint (After Motion) since the step pulses can be delayed from the commanded position due to stepper motor smoothing.

Using an Encoder with Stepper Motors
An encoder may be used on a stepper motor to check the actual motor position with the commanded position. The position of the encoder can be interrogated by using the command TP. The position value can be defined by using the command DE. Note: Closed loop operation with a stepper motor is not possible outside of the application level.

Command Summary - Stepper Motor Operation
Command
DE DP IT KS MT RP TD TP

Description
Define Encoder Position (When using an encoder) Define Reference Position and Step Count Register Motion Profile Smoothing - Independent Time Constant Stepper Motor Smoothing Motor Type (2,-2,2.5 or -2.5 for stepper motors) Report Commanded Position Report number of step pulses generated by controller Tell Position of Encoder

Operand Summary - Stepper Motor Operation
Operand
_DEx _DPx _ITx _KSx _MTx _RPx _TDx _TPx

Description
Contains the value of the step count register for the `x' axis Contains the value of the encoder for the `x' axis Contains the value of the Independent Time constant for the 'x' axis Contains the value of the Stepper Motor Smoothing Constant for the 'x' axis Contains the motor type value for the 'x' axis Contains the commanded position generated by the profiler for the `x' axis Contains the value of the step count register for the `x' axis Contains the value of the main encoder for the `x' axis

82 i Chapter 6 Programming Motion

DMC-14x5/6


Aux Encoder/ Dual Loop (DMC-1415 and DMC-1416 only)
The DMC-141X provides an interface for a second encoder except when the controller is configured for stepper motor operation. When used, the second encoder is typically mounted on the motor or the load, but may be mounted in any position. The most common use for the second encoder is backlash compensation, described below. The second encoder may be of the standard quadrature type, or it may be of the pulse and direction type. The controller also offers the provision for inverting the direction of the encoder rotation. The main and auxiliary encoders are configured with the CE command. The command form is CE x where x equals the sum of n and m below. m=
0 1 2 3

Main Encoder
Normal quadrature Pulse & direction Reverse quadrature Reverse pulse & direction

n=
0 4 8 12

Second Encoder
Normal quadrature Pulse & direction Reversed quadrature Reversed pulse & direction

For example, to configure the main encoder for reversed quadrature, m=2, and a second encoder of pulse and direction, n=4, the total is 6, and the command is CE 6 Additional Commands for the Auxiliary Encoder The DE command can be used to define the position of the auxiliary encoders. For example, DEO sets the initial value. The positions of the auxiliary encoders may be interrogated with DE?. For example DE ? returns the value of the auxiliary encoder. The auxiliary encoder position may be assigned to variables with the instructions V1=_DE The current position of the auxiliary encoder may also be interrogated with the TD command.

Backlash Compensation
The dual loop methods can be used for backlash compensation. This can be done by two approaches: 1. Continuous dual loop 2. Sampled dual loop To illustrate the problem, consider a situation in which the coupling between the motor and the load has a backlash. To compensate for the backlash, position encoders are mounted on both the motor and the load. The continuous dual loop combines the two feedback signals to achieve stability. This method requires careful system tuning, and depends on the magnitude of the backlash. However, once successful, this method compensates for the backlash continuously. The second method, the sampled dual loop, reads the load encoder only at the end point and performs a correction. This method is independent of the size of the backlash. However, it is effective only in point-to-point motion systems which require position accuracy only at the endpoint.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 6 Programming Motion i 83


Continuous Dual Loop - Example Connect the load encoder to the main encoder port and connect the motor encoder to the dual encoder port. The dual loop method splits the filter function between the two encoders. It applies the KP (proportional) and KI (integral) terms to the position error, based on the load encoder, and applies the KD (derivative) term to the motor encoder. This method results in a stable system. Note: It is recommended that the resolution of the rotary encoder be greater than the effective resolution of the load encoder for stability. The dual loop method is activated with the instruction DV (Dual Velocity), where DV 1 activates the dual loop for the four axes and DV 0 disables the dual loop. Note that the dual loop compensation depends on the backlash magnitude, and in extreme cases will not stabilize the loop. The proposed compensation procedure is to start with KP=0, KI=0 and to maximize the value of KD under the condition DV1. Once KD is found, increase KP gradually to a maximum value, and finally, increase KI, if necessary. Sampled Dual Loop - Example In this example, we consider a linear slide that is run by a rotary motor via a lead screw. Since the lead screw has a backlash, it is necessary to use a linear encoder to monitor the position of the slide. For stability reasons, it is best to use a rotary encoder on the motor. Connect the rotary encoder to the main encoders input and connect the linear encoder to the auxiliary encoder input. Let the required motion distance be one inch, and assume that this corresponds to 40,000 counts of the rotary encoder and 10,000 counts of the linear encoder. The design approach is to drive the motor a distance, which corresponds to 40,000 rotary counts. Once the motion is complete, the controller monitors the position of the linear encoder and performs position corrections. This is done by the following program. Instruction Interpretation
#DUALOOP CE 0 DE0 PR 40000 BG #Correct AM V1=10000-_DE V2=-_TE/4+V1 JP#END,@ABS[V2]<2 PR V2*4 BG JP#Correct #END EN Label Configure encoder Set initial value Main move Start motion Correction loop Wait for motion completion Find linear encoder error Compensate for motor error Exit if error is small Correction move Start correction Repeat

84 i Chapter 6 Programming Motion

DMC-14x5/6


Motion Smoothing
The DMC-14XX controller allows the smoothing of the velocity profile to reduce mechanical vibrations in the system. Trapezoidal velocity profiles have acceleration rates which change abruptly from zero to maximum value. The discontinuous acceleration results in jerk which causes vibration. The smoothing of the acceleration profile leads to a continuous acceleration profile and reduces the mechanical shock and vibration.

Using the IT and VT Commands
When operating with servo motors, motion smoothing can be accomplished with the IT and VT commands. These commands filter the acceleration and deceleration functions to produce a smooth velocity profile. The resulting velocity profile, has continuous acceleration and results in reduced mechanical vibrations. The smoothing function is specified by the following commands:
IT x,y VT n Independent time constant Vector time constant

The command IT is used for smoothing independent moves of the type JG, PR, PA and the command VT is used to smooth vector moves of the type VM and LM. The smoothing parameters x,y and n are numbers between 0 and 1 and determine the degree of filtering. The maximum value of 1 implies no filtering, resulting in trapezoidal velocity profiles. Smaller values of the smoothing parameters imply heavier filtering and smoother moves. The following example illustrates the effect of smoothing. Fig. 6.7 shows the trapezoidal velocity profile and the modified acceleration and velocity. Note that the smoothing process results in longer motion time. Example - Smoothing Instruction Interpretation
PR 20000 AC 100000 DC 100000 SP 5000 IT .5 BG X Position Acceleration Deceleration Speed Filter value Begin

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 6 Programming Motion i 85


Figure 6.7 ­ Trapezoidal velocity and smooth velocity profiles

Using the KS Command (Step Motor Smoothing)
When operating with step motors, motion smoothing can be accomplished with the command, KS. The KS command smoothes the frequency of step motor pulses. Similar to the commands IT and VT this produces a smooth velocity profile. The step motor smoothing is specified by the following command:
KS x,y where x,y is an integer from 0.5 to 8 and represents the amount of smoothing

The command, IT, is used for smoothing independent moves of the type JG, PR, PA and the command, VT, is used to smooth vector moves of the type VM and LM. The smoothing parameters, x,y and n are numbers between 0.5 and 8 and determine the degree of filtering. The minimum value of 0.5 implies no filtering, resulting in trapezoidal velocity profiles. Larger values of the smoothing parameters imply heavier filtering and smoother moves. Note that KS is valid only for step motors.

86 i Chapter 6 Programming Motion

DMC-14x5/6


Homing
The Find Edge (FE) and Home (HM) instructions may be used to home the motor to a mechanical reference. This reference is connected to the Home input line. The HM command initializes the motor to the encoder index pulse in addition to the Home input. The configure command (CN) is used to define the polarity of the home input. The Find Edge (FE) instruction is useful for initializing the motor to a home switch. The home switch is connected to the Homing Input. When the Find Edge command and Begin is used, the motor will accelerate up to the slew speed and slew until a transition is detected on the Homing line. The motor will then decelerate to a stop. A high deceleration value must be input before the find edge command is issued for the motor to decelerate rapidly after sensing the home switch. The Home (HM) command can be used to position the motor on the index pulse after the home switch is detected. This allows for finer positioning on initialization. The HM command and BG command causes the following sequence of events to occur.

Stage 1:
Upon begin, the motor accelerates to the slew speed specified by the JG or SP commands. The direction of its motion is determined by the state of the homing input. If _HMX reads 1 initially, the motor will go in the reverse direction first (direction of decreasing encoder counts). If _HMX reads 0 initially, the motor will go in the forward direction first. CN is the command used to define the polarity of the home input. With CN,-1 (the default value) a normally open switch will make _HMX read 1 initially, and a normally closed switch will make _HMX read zero. Furthermore, with CN,1 a normally open switch will make _HMX read 0 initially, and a normally closed switch will make _HMX read 1. Therefore, the CN command will need to be configured properly to ensure the correct direction of motion in the home sequence. Upon detecting the home switch changing state, the motor begins decelerating to a stop. Note: The direction of motion for the FE command also follows these rules for the state of the home input.

Stage 2:
The motor then traverses at 256 counts/sec in the opposite direction of Stage 1 until the home switch toggles again. If Stage 3 is in the opposite direction of Stage 2, the motor will stop immediately at this point and change direction. If Stage 2 is in the same direction as Stage 3, the motor will never stop, but will smoothly continue into Stage 3.

Stage 3:
The motor traverses forward at 256 counts/sec until the encoder index pulse is detected. The motor then stops immediately. The DMC-141X defines the home position as the position at which the index was detected and sets the encoder reading at this point to zero.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 6 Programming Motion i 87


The 4 different motion possibilities for the home sequence are shown in the following table.
Direction of Motion Switch Type Normally Open Normally Open Normally Closed Normally Closed CN Setting CN,-1 CN,1 CN,-1 CN,1 Initial _HMX state 1 0 0 1 Stage 1 Reverse Forward Forward Reverse Stage 2 Forward Reverse Reverse Forward Stage 3 Forward Forward Forward Forward

Example: Homing Instruction
#HOME CN,-1 AC 1000000 DC 1000000 SP 5000 HM BG AM MG "AT HOME" EN

Interpretation
Label Configure the polarity of the home input Acceleration Rate Deceleration Rate Speed for Home Search Home Begin Motion After Complete Send Message End

Figure 6.8 shows the velocity profile from the homing sequence of the example program above. For this profile, the switch is normally closed and CN,-1.

88 i Chapter 6 Programming Motion

DMC-14x5/6


HOME SW ITCH

_HMX=0

_HMX=1 POSITION

VELOCITY MOTION BEGINS IN FORW ARD DIRECTION

POSITION VELOCITY MOTION CHANGES DIRECTION POSITION

VELOCITY MOTION IN FORW ARD DIRECTION TOW ARD INDEX POSITION

INDEX PULSES

POSITION

Figure 6.8 ­ Homing Sequence for Normally Closed Switch and CN,-1 Example: Find Edge
#EDGE AC 2000000 DC 2000000 SP 8000 Label Acceleration rate Deceleration rate Speed

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 6 Programming Motion i 89


FE BG AM MG "FOUND HOME" DP 0 EN

Find edge command Begin motion After complete Send message Define position as 0 End

High Speed Position Capture
Often it is desirable to capture the position precisely for registration applications. The DMC-141X provides a position latch feature. This feature allows the position to be captured in less than 1 sec of the external low or high input signal. The DMC-141X software commands, AL and RL, are used to arm the latch and report the latched position. The steps to use the latch are as follows: 1. 2. Give the AL command, to arm the latch. Test to see if the latch has occurred (Input 1 goes low) by using the _AL command. Example, V1=_AL returns the state of the latch into V1. V1 is 1 if the latch has not occurred. After the latch has occurred, read the captured position with the report latch RL command or _RL.

3.

Note: The latch must be re-armed after each latching event. Example: High Speed Latch Instruction Interpretation
#Latch JG 5000 BG AL #Wait JP #Wait,_AL=1 Result=_RL Result= EN Latch program Jog Begin Arm Latch Loop for Latch=1 Wait for latch Report position Print result End

90 i Chapter 6 Programming Motion

DMC-14x5/6


Chapter 7 Application Programming

Overview
The DMC-14XX provides a powerful programming language that allows users to customize the controller for their particular application. Programs can be downloaded into the DMC-14XX memory freeing the host computer for other tasks. However, the host computer can send commands to the controller at any time, even while a program is being executed. Only ASCII commands can be used for application programming. In addition to standard motion commands, the DMC-14XX provides commands that allow the DMC14XX to make its own decisions. These commands include conditional jumps, event triggers, and subroutines. For example, the command JP#LOOP, n<10 causes a jump to the label #LOOP if the variable n is less than 10. For greater programming flexibility, the DMC-14XX provides user-defined variables, arrays, and arithmetic functions. For example, with a cut-to-length operation, the length can be specified as a variable in a program which the operator can change as necessary. The following sections in this chapter discuss all aspects of creating applications programs. The program memory size is 80 characters x 500 lines.

Using the DMC-14XX Editor to Enter Programs
The DMC-14XX has an internal editor, which may be used to create and edit programs in the controller's memory. The internal editor is opened by the command ED. Note that the command ED will not open the internal editor if issued from Galil's Window based software ­ in this case, a Windows based editor will be automatically opened. The Windows based editor provides much more functionality and ease-of-use, therefore, the internal editor is most useful when using a simple terminal with the controller and a Windows based editor is not available. In the Edit Mode, each program line is automatically numbered sequentially starting with 000. If no parameter follows the ED command, the editor prompter will default to the last line of the last program in memory. If desired, the user can edit a specific line number or label by specifying a line number or label following ED.
:ED :ED 5 :ED #BEGIN Puts Editor at end of last program Puts Editor at line 5 Puts Editor at label #BEGIN

Line numbers appear as 000, 001, 002 and so on. Program commands are entered following the line numbers. Multiple commands may be given on a single line as long as the total number of characters doesn't exceed 80 characters per line. While in the Edit Mode, the programmer has access to special instructions for saving, inserting and deleting program lines. These special instructions are listed below:

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 91


Edit Mode Commands
Typing the return key causes the current line of entered instructions to be saved. The editor will automatically advance to the next line. Thus, hitting a series of will cause the editor to advance a series of lines. Note, changes on a program line will not be saved unless a is given. P The P command moves the editor to the previous line. I The I command inserts a line above the current line. For example, if the editor is at line number 2 and I is applied, a new line will be inserted between lines 1 and 2. This new line will be labeled line 2. The old line number 2 is renumbered as line 3. D The D command deletes the line currently being edited. For example, if the editor is at line number 2 and D is applied, line 2 will be deleted. The previous line number 3 is now renumbered as line number 2. Q The Q quits the editor mode. In response, the DMC-14XX will return a colon. After the Edit session is over, the user may list the entered program using the LS command. If no operand follows the LS command, the entire program will be listed. The user can start listing at a specific line or label using the operand n. A command and new line number or label following the start listing operand specifies the location at which listing is to stop. Example: Instruction
:LS :LS 5 :LS 5,9 :LS #A,9 :LS #A, #A +5

Interpretation
List entire program Begin listing at line 5 List lines 5 thru 9 List line label #A thru line 9 List line label #A and additional 5 lines

Program Format
A DMC-14XX program consists of DMC-14XX application. Action instructions, such as starting Flow instructions to form the complete program. conditions, such as elapsed time or motion comp instructions combined to solve a machine control and stopping motion, are combined with Program Program Flow instructions evaluate real-time lete, and alter program flow accordingly.

Each DMC-14XX instruction in a program must be separated by a delimiter. Valid delimiters are the semicolon (;) or carriage return. The semicolon is used to separate multiple instructions on a single program line where the maximum number of characters on a line is 80 (including semicolons). A carriage return enters the final command on a program line.

Using Labels in Programs
All DMC-14XX programs must begin with a label and end with an End (EN) statement. Labels start with the pound (#) sign followed by a maximum of seven characters. The first character must be a letter; after that, numbers are permitted. Spaces are not permitted.

92 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


The maximum number of labels, which may be defined, is 126. Valid labels #BEGIN #SQUARE #X1 #begin1 Invalid labels #1Square #123 A Simple Example Program: Instruction Interpretation
#START PR 10000,20000 BG XY AM WT 2000 JP #START EN Beginning of the Program Specify relative distances on X and Y axes Begin Motion Wait for motion complete Wait 2 sec Jump to label START End of Program

The above program moves X and Y, 10000 and 20000 units respectively. After the motion is complete, the motors rest for 2 seconds. The cycle repeats indefinitely until the ST or HX command is issued.

Special Labels
The DMC-141X also has some special labels, which are used to define input interrupt subroutines, limit switch subroutines, error handling subroutines, and command error subroutines. The following table lists the automatic subroutines supported by the controller. Sample programs for these subroutines can be found in the section Automatic Subroutines for Monitoring Conditions.
#AUTO #AUTOERR #ININT #LIMSWI #POSERR #MCTIME #CMDERR #TCPERR Starts program on power-up or reset Starts program on power-up error Label for input interrupt subroutine Label for limit switch subroutine Label for excess position error subroutine Label for timeout on motion complete trip point Label for incorrect command subroutine Ethernet communication error

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 93


Commenting Programs Using the command, NO
The DMC-14XX provides a command, NO, for commenting programs. This command allows the user to include up to 78 characters on a single line after the NO command and can be used to include comments from the programmer as in the following example:
#PATH NO 2-D CIRCULAR PATH VMXY NO VECTOR MOTION ON X AND Y VS 10000 NO VECTOR SPEED IS 10000 VP -4000,0 NO BOTTOM LINE CR 1500,270,-180 NO HALF CIRCLE MOTION VP 0,3000 NO TOP LINE CR 1500,90,-180 NO HALF CIRCLE MOTION VE NO END VECTOR SEQUENCE BGS NO BEGIN SEQUENCE MOTION EN NO END OF PROGRAM

Note 1: The NO command is an actual controller command. Therefore, inclusion of the NO commands will require process time by the controller. Note 2: On the DMC-1415/1416/1425 controllers, an apostrophe ` may be used instead of the NO command to document a program

Using REM Statements with the Galil Terminal Software.
If you are using Galil software to communicate with the DMC-14XX controller, you may also include REM, remark, statements. `REM' statements begin with the word `REM' and may be followed by any comments which are on the same line. The Galil terminal software will remove these statements when the program is downloaded to the controller. For example:
#PATH REM 2-D CIRCULAR PATH VMXY REM VECTOR MOTION ON X AND Y VS 10000 REM VECTOR SPEED IS 10000 VP -4000,0 REM BOTTOM LINE CR 1500,270,-180

94 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


REM HALF CIRCLE MOTION VP 0,3000 REM TOP LINE CR 1500,90,-180 REM HALF CIRCLE MOTION VE REM END VECTOR SEQUENCE BGS REM BEGIN SEQUENCE MOTION EN REM END OF PROGRAM

The REM statements will be removed when the program is downloaded to the controller.

Executing Programs - Multitasking
The DMC-14XX can run up to two independent programs simultaneously. These programs are called threads and are numbered 0 and 1, where 0 is the main thread. Multitasking is useful for executing independent operations such as PLC functions that occur independently of motion. The main thread differs from the others in the following ways: 1. Only the main thread, thread 0, may use the input command, IN. 2. When input interrupts are implemented for limit switches, position errors or command errors, the subroutines are executed as thread 0. To begin execution of the various programs, use the following instruction: XQ #A, n Where n indicates the thread number. To halt the execution of any thread, use the instruction HX n where n is the thread number. Note that both the XQ and HX commands can be performed by an executing program. The example below produces a waveform on Output 1 independent of a move. Instruction Interpretation
#TASK1 AT0 CB1 #LOOP1 AT 10 SB1 AT -40 CB1 JP #LOOP1 #TASK2 XQ #TASK1,1 #LOOP2 PR 1000 Task1 label Initialize reference time Clear Output 1 Loop1 label Wait 10 msec from reference time Set Output 1 Wait 40 msec from reference time, then initialize reference Clear Output 1 Repeat Loop1 Task2 label Execute Task1 Loop2 label Define relative distance

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 95


BGX AMX WT 10 JP #LOOP2,@IN[2]=1 HX

Begin motion After motion done Wait 10 msec Repeat motion unless Input 2 is low Halt all tasks

The program above is executed with the instruction XQ #TASK2,0 which designates TASK2 as the main thread (i.e. Thread 0). #TASK1 is executed within TASK2.

Debugging Programs
The DMC-14XX provides commands and operands which are useful in debugging application programs. These commands include interrogation commands to monitor program execution, determine the state of the controller and the contents of the controllers program, array, and variable space. Operands also contain important status information which can help to debug a program.

Trace Commands
The trace command causes the controller to send each line in a program to the host computer immediately prior to execution. Tracing is enabled with the command, TR1. TR0 turns the trace function off. Note: When the trace function is enabled, the line numbers as well as the command line will be displayed as each command line is executed. To route the trace to the controller's serial port, use CFS. To route the trace to the Ethernet, use CFA. TH shows which Ethernet handles are in use. CW1 or CW2 may need to be issued of no output is seen.

Error Code Command
When there is a program error, the DMC-14XX halts the program execution at the point where the error occurs. To display the last line number of program execution, issue the command, MG _ED. The user can obtain information about the type of error condition that occurred by using the command, TC1. This command reports back a number and a text message which describes the error condition. The command, TC0 or TC, will return the error code without the text message. For more information about the command, TC, see the Command Reference.

Stop Code Command
The status of motion for each axis can be determined by using the stop code command, SC. This can be useful when motion on an axis has stopped unexpectedly. The command SC will return a number representing the motion status. See the command reference for further information.

Breakpoint Command
The BK command is used to set breakpoint in application programs, and the SL command is used to single step from the breakpoint.

RAM Memory Interrogation Commands
For debugging the status of the program memory, array memory, or variable memory, the DMC-14XX has several useful commands. The command, DM ?, will return the number of array elements currently available. The command, DA ?, will return the number of arrays which can be currently defined. For example, a standard DMC-1415 will have a maximum of 2000 array elements in up to 14 arrays. If an array of 100 elements is defined, the command DM ? will return the value 1900 and the command DA ? will return 13.

96 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


To list the contents of the variable space, use the interrogation command LV (List Variables). To list the contents of array space, use the interrogation command LA (List Arrays). To list the contents of the Program space, use the interrogation command LS (List). To list the application program labels only, use the interrogation command LL (List Labels).

Operands
In general, all operands provide information which may be useful in debugging an application program. Below is a list of operands which are particularly valuable for program debugging. To display the value of an operand, the message command may be used. For example, since the operand, _ED contains the last line of program execution, the command MG _ED will display this line number. _ED contains the last line of program execution. Useful to determine where program stopped. _DL contains the number of available labels (126 max.) _UL contains the number of available variables (126 max.) _DA contains the number of available arrays (14 max.) _DM contains the number of available array elements (2000 max.) _AB contains the state of the Abort Input _LFx contains the state of the forward limit switch for the 'x' axis _LRx contains the state of the reverse limit switch for the 'x' axis

Debugging Example:
The following program has an error. It attempts to specify a relative movement while the X-axis is already in motion. When the program is executed, the controller stops at line 003. The user can then query the controller using the command, TC1. The controller responds with the corresponding explanation: Instruction Interpretation
:ED 000 #A 001 PR1000 002 BGX 003 PR5000 004 EN Q :XQ #A ?003 PR5000 :TC1 Edit Mode Program Label Position Relative 1000 Begin Position Relative 5000 End Quit Edit Mode Execute #A Error on Line 3 Tell Error Code

?7 Command not valid while Command not valid while running running. :ED 3 003 AMX;PR5000;BGX Q :XQ #A Edit Line 3 Add After Motion Command Quit Edit Mode Execute #A

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 97


Program Flow Commands
The DMC-14XX provides instructions to control program flow. The DMC-14XX program sequencer normally executes program instructions sequentially. The program flow can be altered with the use of event triggers, trippoints, and conditional jump statements.

Event Triggers & Trippoints
To function independently from the host computer, the DMC-14XX can be programmed to make decisions based on the occurrence of an event. Such events include waiting for motion to be complete, waiting for a specified amount of time to elapse, or waiting for an input to change logic levels. The DMC-14XX provides several event triggers that cause the program sequencer to halt until the specified event occurs. Normally, a program is automatically executed sequentially one line at a time. When an event trigger instruction is decoded, however, the actual program sequence is halted. The program sequence does not continue until the event trigger is "tripped". For example, the motion complete trigger can be used to separate two move sequences in a program. The commands for the second move sequence will not be executed until the motion is complete on the first motion sequence. In this way, the DMC-14XX can make decisions based on its own status or external events without intervention from a host computer.

98 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


DMC-14XX Event Triggers Command
AM X Y or S

Function
Halts program execution until motion is complete on the specified axes or motion sequence(s). AM with no parameter tests for motion complete on all axes. This command is useful for separating motion sequences in a program. Halts program execution until position command has reached the specified relative distance from the start of the move. Only one axis may be specified at a time. Halts program execution until after specified distance from the last AR or AD command has elapsed. Only one axis may be specified at a time. Halts program execution until after absolute position occurs. Only one axis may be specified at a time. Halt program execution until after forward motion reached absolute position. Only one axis may be specified. If position is already past the point, then MF will trip immediately. Will function on geared axis or aux. inputs. Halt program execution until after reverse motion reached absolute position. Only one axis may be specified. If position is already past the point, then MR will trip immediately. Will function on geared axis or aux. inputs. Halt program execution until after the motion profile has been completed and the encoder has entered or passed the specified position. TW x,y sets timeout to declare an error if not in position. If timeout occurs, then the trippoint will clear and the stop code will be set to 99. An application program will jump to label #MCTIME. Halts program execution until after specified input is at specified logic level. n specifies input line. Positive is high logic level, negative is low level. n=1 through 7 for DMC-14XX. Halts program execution until specified axis has reached its slew speed. Halts program execution until n msec from reference time. AT 0 sets reference. AT n waits n msec from reference. AT -n waits n msec from reference and sets new reference after elapsed time. Halts program execution until specified distance along a coordinated path has occurred. Halts program execution until specified time in msec has elapsed.

AD X or Y

AR X or Y

AP X or Y MF X or Y

MR X or Y

MC X or Y

AI +/- n

AS X Y or S AT +/-n

AV n WT n

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 99


Event Trigger Examples:
Event Trigger - Multiple Move Sequence The AM trippoint is used to separate the two PR moves. If AM is not used, the controller returns a ? for the second PR command because a new PR cannot be given until motion is complete. Instruction Interpretation
#TWOMOVE PR 2000 BGX AMX PR 4000 BGX EN Label Position Command Begin Motion Wait for Motion Complete Next Position Move Begin 2nd move End program

Event Trigger - Set Output after Distance Set output bit 1 after a distance of 1000 counts from the start of the move. The accuracy of the trippoint is the speed multiplied by the sample period. Instruction Interpretation
#SETBIT SP 10000 PA 20000 BGX AD 1000 SB1 EN Label Speed is 10000 Specify Absolute position Begin motion Wait until 1000 counts Set output bit 1 End program

Event Trigger - Repetitive Position Trigger To set the output bit every 10000 counts during a move, the AR trippoint is used as shown in the next example. Instruction Interpretation
#TRIP JG 50000 BGX;n=0 #REPEAT AR 10000 TPX SB1 WT50 CB1 n=n+1 JP #REPEAT,n<5 STX EN Label Specify Jog Speed Begin Motion # Repeat Loop Wait 10000 counts Tell Position Set output 1 Wait 50 msec Clear output 1 Increment counter Repeat 5 times Stop End

100 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


Event Trigger - Start Motion on Input This example waits for input 1 to go low and then starts motion. Note: The AI command actually halts execution of the program until the input occurs. If you do not want to halt the program sequences, you can use the Input Interrupt function (II) or use a conditional jump on an input, such as JP #GO,@IN[1] = 0. Instruction Interpretation
#INPUT AI-1 PR 10000 BGX EN Program Label Wait for input 1 low Position command Begin motion End program

Event Trigger - Set output when At speed Instruction
#ATSPEED JG 50000 AC 10000 BGX ASX SB1 EN

Interpretation
Program Label Specify jog speed Acceleration rate Begin motion Wait for at slew speed 50000 Set output 1 End program

Event Trigger - Change Speed along Vector Path The following program changes the feedrate or vector speed at the specified distance along the vector. The vector distance is measured from the start of the move or from the last AV command. Instruction Interpretation
#VECTOR VMXY;VS 5000 VP 10000,20000 VP 20000,30000 VE BGS AV 5000 VS 1000 EN Label Coordinated path Vector position Vector position End vector Begin sequence After vector distance Reduce speed End

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 101


Event Trigger - Multiple Move with Wait This example makes multiple relative distance moves by waiting for each to be complete before executing new moves. Instruction Interpretation
#MOVES PR 12000 SP 20000 AC 100000 BGX AD 10000 SP 5000 AMX WT 200 PR -10000 SP 30000 AC 150000 BGX EN Label Distance Speed Acceleration Start Motion Wait a distance of 10,000 counts New Speed Wait until motion is completed Wait 200 ms New Position New Speed New Acceleration Start Motion End

Define Output Waveform Using AT The following program causes Output 1 to be high for 10 msec and low for 40 msec. The cycle repeats every 50 msec. Instruction Interpretation
#OUTPUT AT0 SB1 #LOOP AT 10 CB1 AT -40 SB1 JP #LOOP EN Program label Initialize time reference Set Output 1 Loop After 10 msec from reference, Clear Output 1 Wait 40 msec from reference and reset reference Set Output 1 Loop

Conditional Jumps
The DMC-14XX provides Conditional Jump (JP) and Conditional Jump to Subroutine (JS) instructions for branching to a new program location based on a specified condition. The conditional jump determines if a condition is satisfied and then branches to a new location or subroutine. Unlike event triggers, the conditional jump instruction does not halt the program sequence. Conditional jumps are useful for testing events in real-time. They allow the DMC-14XX to make decisions without a host computer. For example, the DMC-14XX can decide between two motion profiles based on the state of an input line. Command Format - JP and JS Format
JS destination, logical condition

Description
Jump to subroutine if logical condition is satisfied

102 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


JP destination, logical condition

Jump to location if logical condition is satisfied

The destination is a program line number or label where the program sequencer will jump if the specified condition is satisfied. Note that the line number of the first line of program memory is 0. The comma designates "IF". The logical condition tests two operands with logical operators. Logical operators: Operator
< > = <= >= <>

Description
less than greater than equal to less than or equal to greater than or equal to not equal

Conditional Statements The conditional statement is satisfied if it evaluates to any value other than zero. The conditional statement can be any valid DMC-14XX numeric operand, including variables, array elements, numeric values, functions, keywords, and arithmetic expressions. If no conditional statement is given, the jump will always occur. Examples:
Number Numeric Expression Array Element Variable Internal Variable I/O V1=6 V1=V7*6 @ABS[V1]>10 V1500 V1>@AN[2] @IN[1]=0

Multiple Conditional Statements The DMC-14XX will accept multiple conditions in a single jump statement. The conditional statements are combined in pairs using the operands "&" and "|". The "&" operand between any two conditions, requires that both statements must be true for the combined statement to be true. The "|" operand between any two conditions, requires that only one statement be true for the combined statement to be true. Note: Each condition must be placed in parentheses for proper evaluation by the controller. In addition, the DMC-14XX executes operations from left to right. For further information on Mathematical Expressions and the bit-wise operators `&' and `|', see pg. 110. For example, using variables named V1, V2, V3 and V4: JP #TEST, (V1
DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 103


This statement will cause the program to jump to the label #TEST under two conditions; 1. If V1 is less than V2 AND V3 is less than V4. 2. If V5 is less than V6. Using the JP Command: If the condition for the JP command is satisfied, the controller branches to the specified label or line number and continues executing commands from this point. If the condition is not satisfied, the controller continues to execute the next commands in sequence. Instruction
JP #Loop,COUNT<10 JS #MOVE2,@IN[1]=1

Interpretation
Jump to #Loop if the variable, COUNT, is less than 10 Jump to subroutine #MOVE2 if input 1 is logic level high. After the subroutine MOVE2 is executed, the program sequencer returns to the main program location where the subroutine was called. Jump to #BLUE if the absolute value of variable, V2, is greater than 2 Jump to #C if the value of V1 times V7 is less than or equal to the value of V8*V2 Jump to #A

JP #BLUE,@ABS[V2]>2 JP #C,V1*V7<=V8*V2 JP#A

Example Using JP command: Move the X motor to absolute position 1000 counts and back to zero ten times. Wait 100 msec between moves. Instruction Interpretation
#BEGIN COUNT=10 #LOOP PA 1000 BGX AMX WT 100 PA 0 BGX AMX WT 100 COUNT=COUNT-1 JP #LOOP,COUNT>0 EN Begin Program Initialize loop counter Begin loop Position absolute 1000 Begin move Wait for motion complete Wait 100 msec Position absolute 0 Begin move Wait for motion complete Wait 100 msec Decrement loop counter Test for 10 times thru loop End Program

Using If, Else, and Endif Commands
The DMC-14XX provides a structured approach to conditional statements using IF, ELSE and ENDIF commands. Using the IF and ENDIF Commands An IF conditional statement is formed by the combination of an IF and ENDIF command. The IF command has as it's arguments one or more conditional statements. If the conditional statement(s) evaluates true, the command interpreter will continue executing commands which follow the IF command. If the conditional statement evaluates false, the controller will ignore commands until the associated ENDIF command is executed OR an ELSE command occurs in the program (see discussion of ELSE command below).

104 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


Note: An ENDIF command must always be executed for every IF command that has been executed. It is recommended that the user not include jump commands inside IF conditional statements since this causes re-direction of command execution. In this case, the command interpreter may not execute an ENDIF command. Using the ELSE Command The ELSE command is an optional part of an IF conditional statement and allows for the execution of command only when the argument of the IF command evaluates False. The ELSE command must occur after an IF command and has no arguments. If the argument of the IF command evaluates false, the controller will skip commands until the ELSE command. If the argument for the IF command evaluates true, the controller will execute the commands between the IF and ELSE command. Nesting IF Conditional Statements The DMC-14XX allows for IF conditional statements to be included within other IF conditional statements. This technique is known as 'nesting' and the DMC-14XX allows up to 255 IF conditional statements to be nested. This is a very powerful technique allowing the user to specify a variety of different cases for branching. Command Format - IF, ELSE and ENDIF Function
IF conditional statement(s)

Condition
Execute commands proceeding IF command (up to ELSE command) if conditional statement(s) is true, otherwise continue executing at ENDIF command or optional ELSE command. Optional command. Allows for commands to be executed when argument of IF command evaluates not true. Can only be used with IF command. Command to end IF conditional statement. Program must have an ENDIF command for every IF command.

ELSE ENDIF

Example using IF, ELSE and ENDIF: Instruction
#TEST II,,3 MG "WAITING FOR INPUT 1, INPUT 2" #LOOP JP #LOOP EN #ININT IF (@IN[1]=0) IF (@IN[2]=0) MG "INPUT 1 AND INPUT 2 ARE ACTIVE" ELSE MG "ONLY INPUT 1 IS ACTIVE ENDIF ELSE MG"ONLY INPUT 2 IS ACTIVE" ENDIF #WAIT

Interpretation
Begin Main Program "TEST" Enable input interrupts on input 1 and input 2 Output message Label to be used for endless loop Endless loop End of main program Input Interrupt Subroutine IF conditional statement based on input 1 2nd IF conditional statement executed if 1st IF conditional true Message to be executed if 2nd IF conditional is true ELSE command for 2nd IF conditional statement Message to be executed if 2nd IF conditional is false End of 2nd conditional statement ELSE command for 1st IF conditional statement Message to be executed if 1st IF conditional statement End of 1st conditional statement Label to be used for a loop

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 105


JP#WAIT,(@IN[1]=0) | (@IN[2]=0) RI0

Loop until both input 1 and input 2 are not active End Input Interrupt Routine without restoring trippoints

Subroutines
A subroutine is a group of instructions beginning with a label and ending with an end command (EN). Subroutines are called from the main program with the jump subroutine instruction JS, followed by a label or line number, and conditional statement. Up to 8 subroutines can be nested. After the subroutine is executed, the program sequencer returns to the program location where the subroutine was called unless the subroutine stack is manipulated as described in the following section. Example: An example of a subroutine which draws a square 500 counts per side is given below. The square is drawn at vector position 1000,1000. Instruction Interpretation
#M CB1 VP 1000,1000;LE;BGS AMS SB1 JS #Square;CB1 EN #Square V1=500;JS #L V1=-V1;JS #L EN #L;PR V1,V1;BGX AMX;BGY;AMY EN Begin Main Program Clear Output Bit 1 (pick up pen) Define vector position; move pen Wait for after motion trippoint Set Output Bit 1 (put down pen) Jump to square subroutine End Main Program Square subroutine Define length of side Switch direction End subroutine Define X,Y; Begin X After motion on X, Begin Y End subroutine

Stack Manipulation
It is possible to manipulate the subroutine stack by using the ZS command. Every time a JS instruction, interrupt or automatic routine (such as #POSERR or #LIMSWI) is executed, the subroutine stack is incremented by 1. Normally the stack is restored with an EN instruction. Occasionally it is desirable not to return back to the program line where the subroutine or interrupt was called. The ZS1 command clears 1 level of the stack. This allows the program sequencer to continue to the next line. The ZS0 command resets the stack to its initial value. For example, if a limit occurs and the #LIMSWI routine is executed, it is often desirable to restart the program sequence instead of returning to the location where the limit occurred. To do this, give a ZS command at the end of the #LIMSWI routine.

Auto-Start Routine
The DMC-14XX has two special labels for automatic program execution. A program which has been saved into the controllers non-volatile memory can be automatically executed upon power up or reset by beginning the program with the label #AUTO. On power up, if there is a checksum error, then #AUTO does not execute, but #AUTOERR executes instead. The program must be saved into nonvolatile memory using the command, BP.

106 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


Automatic Subroutines for Monitoring Conditions
Often it is desirable to monitor certain conditions continuously without tying up the host or DMC14XX program sequences. The DMC-14XX can monitor several important conditions in the background. These conditions include checking for the occurrence of a limit switch, a defined input, position error, or a command error. Automatic monitoring is enabled by inserting a special, predefined label in the applications program. The pre-defined labels are:

Subroutine
#LIMSWI #ININT #POSERR #MCTIME #CMDERR #TCPERR

Description
Limit switch on any axis goes low Input specified by II goes low Position error exceeds limit specified by ER Motion Complete timeout occurred. Timeout period set by TW command Bad command given Ethernet communication error

For example, the #POSERR subroutine will automatically be executed when any axis exceeds its position error limit. The commands in the #POSERR subroutine could decode which axis is in error and take the appropriate action. In another example, the #ININT label could be used to designate an input interrupt subroutine. When the specified input occurs, the program will be executed automatically. NOTE: An application program must be running for automatic monitoring to function. Example - Limit Switch: This program prints a message upon the occurrence of a limit switch. Note, for the #LIMSWI routine to function, the DMC-14XX must be executing an applications program from memory. This can be a very simple program that does nothing but loop on a statement, such as #LOOP;JP #LOOP;EN. Motion commands, such as JG 5000 can still be sent from the PC even while the "dummy" applications program is being executed. Instruction Interpretation
:ED 000 #LOOP 001 JP #LOOP;EN 002 #LIMSWI 003 MG "LIMIT OCCURRED" 004 RE Q :XQ #LOOP :JG 5000 :BGX Edit Mode Dummy Program Jump to Loop Limit Switch Label Print Message Return to main program Quit Edit Mode Execute Dummy Program Jog Begin Motion

Now, when a forward limit switch occurs on the X axis, the #LIMSWI subroutine will be executed. Notes regarding the #LIMSWI Routine: 1) The RE command is used to return from the #LIMSWI subroutine. 2) The #LIMSWI subroutine will be re-executed if the limit switch remains active. The #LIMSWI routine is only executed when the motor is being commanded to move

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 107


Example - Position Error Instruction
:ED 000 #LOOP 001 JP #LOOP;EN 002 #POSERR 003 V1=_TEX 004 MG "EXCESS POSITION ERROR" 005 MG "ERROR=",V1= 006 RE Q :XQ #LOOP :JG 100000 :BGX

Interpretation
Edit Mode Dummy Program Loop Position Error Routine Read Position Error Print Message Print Error Return from Error Quit Edit Mode Execute Dummy Program Jog at High Speed Begin Motion

Now, when excess position error occurs on the X axis, the #POSERR subroutine will be executed. Example - Input Interrupt Instruction
#A II1 JG 30000,60000 BGXY #LOOP;JP#LOOP;EN #ININT STXY;AM #TEST;JP #TEST, @IN[1]=0 JG 30000,6000 BGXY RI0

Interpretation
Label Input Interrupt on 1 Jog Begin Motion Loop Input Interrupt Stop Motion Test for Input 1 still low Restore Velocities Begin motion Return from interrupt routine to Main Program and do not re-enable trippoints

Example - Motion Complete Timeout Instruction
#BEGIN TW 1000 PA 10000 BGX MCX EN #MCTIME MG "X fell short" EN

Interpretation
Begin main program Set the time out to 1000 ms Position Absolute command Begin motion Motion Complete trip point End main program Motion Complete Subroutine Send out a message End subroutine

108 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


This simple program will issue the message "X fell short" if the X axis does not reach the commanded position within 1 second of the end of the profiled move. Example - Command Error Instruction
#BEGIN IN "ENTER SPEED", SPEED JG SPEED;BGX; JP #BEGIN EN #CMDERR JP#DONE,_ED<>2 JP#DONE,_TC<>6 MG "SPEED TOO HIGH" MG "TRY AGAIN" ZS1 JP #BEGIN #DONE ZS0 EN

Interpretation
Begin main program Prompt for speed Begin motion Repeat End main program Command error utility Check if error on line 2 Check if out of range Send message Send message Adjust stack Return to main program End program if other error Zero stack End program

The above program prompts the operator to enter a jog speed. If the operator enters a number out of range (greater than 8 million), the #CMDERR routine will be executed prompting the operator to enter a new number. In multitasking applications, there is an alternate method for handling command errors from different threads. Using the XQ command along with the special operands described below allows the controller to either skip or retry invalid commands. Operand
_ED1 _ED2 _ED3

Function
Returns the number of the thread that generated an error Retry failed command (operand contains the location of the failed command) Skip failed command (operand contains the location of the command after the failed command)

The operands are used with the XQ command in the following format: XQ _ED2 (or _ED3),_ED1,1 Where the ",1" at the end of the command line indicates a restart; therefore, the existing program stack will not be removed when the above format executes. The following example shows an error correction routine which uses the operands. Example - Command Error w/Multitasking Instruction Interpretation
#A JP#A EN End of thread 0 Begin thread 0 (continuous loop)

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 109


#B N=-1 KP N TY EN #CMDERR IF _TC=6 N=1 XQ _ED2,_ED1,1 ENDIF IF _TC=1 XQ _ED3,_ED1,1 ENDIF EN

Begin thread 1 Create new variable Set KP to value of N, an invalid value Issue invalid command End of thread 1 Begin command error subroutine If error is out of range (KP -1) Set N to a valid number Retry KP N command If error is invalid command (TY) Skip invalid command End of command error routine

Example ­ Ethernet Communication Error This simple program executes in the IOC-7007 and indicates (via the serial port) when a communication handle fails. By monitoring the serial port, the user can re-establish communication if needed. Instruction
#LOOP JP#LOOP EN #TCPERR MG {P1}_IA4 RE Ethernet communication error auto routine Send message to serial port indicating which handle did not receive proper acknowledgement Return to main program

Interpretation
Simple program loop

Note: The #TCPERR routine only detects the loss of TCP/IP Ethernet handles, not UDP.

Mathematical and Functional Expressions
Mathematical Operators
For manipulation of data, the DMC-14XX provides the use of the following mathematical operators: Operator
+ * /

Function
Addition Subtraction Multiplication Division

110 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


& | ()

Logical And (Bit-wise) Logical Or (On some computers, a solid vertical line appears as a broken line) Parenthesis

The numeric range for addition, subtraction and multiplication operations is +/-2,147,483,647.9999. The precision for division is 1/65,000. Mathematical operations are executed from left to right. Calculations within parentheses have precedence. Examples:
SPEED=7.5*V1/2 COUNT=COUNT+2 RESULT=_TPX-(@COS[45]*40) TEMP=@IN[1]&@IN[2] The variable, SPEED, is equal to 7.5 multiplied by V1 and divided by 2 The variable, COUNT, is equal to the current value plus 2. Puts the position of X - 28.28 in RESULT. 40 * cosine of 45° is 28.28 TEMP is equal to 1 only if Input 1 and Input 2 are high

Bit-Wise Operators
The mathematical operators & and | are bit-wise operators. The operator, &, is a Logical And. The operator, |, is a Logical Or. These operators allow for bit-wise operations on any valid DMC-14XX numeric operand, including variables, array elements, numeric values, functions, keywords, and arithmetic expressions. The bit-wise operators may also be used with strings. This is useful for separating characters from an input string. When using the input command for string input, the input variable will hold up to 6 characters. These characters are combined into a single value which is represented as 32 bits of integer and 16 bits of fraction. Each ASCII character is represented as one byte (8 bits), therefore the input variable can hold up to six characters. The first character of the string will be placed in the top byte of the variable and the last character will be placed in the lowest significant byte of the fraction. The characters can be individually separated by using bit-wise operations as illustrated in the following example: Instruction Interpretation
#TEST IN "ENTER",LEN{S6} FLEN=@FRAC[LEN] FLEN=$10000*FLEN LEN1=(FLEN&$00FF) LEN2=(FLEN&$FF00)/$100 LEN3=LEN&$000000FF LEN4=(LEN&$0000FF00)/$100 LEN5=(LEN&$00FF0000)/$10000 LEN6=(LEN&$FF000000)/$1000000 MG LEN6 {S4} MG LEN5 {S4} MG LEN4 {S4} MG LEN3 {S4} MG LEN2 {S4} MG LEN1 {S4} EN Begin main program Input character string of up to 6 characters into variable `LEN' Define variable `FLEN' as fractional part of variable `LEN' Shift FLEN by 32 bits (IE - convert fraction, FLEN, to integer) Mask top byte of FLEN and set this value to variable `LEN1' Let variable, `LEN2' = top byte of FLEN Let variable, `LEN3' = bottom byte of LEN Let variable, `LEN4' = second byte of LEN Let variable, `LEN5' = third byte of LEN Let variable, `LEN6' = fourth byte of LEN Display `LEN6' as string message of up to 4 chars Display `LEN5' as string message of up to 4 chars Display `LEN4' as string message of up to 4 chars Display `LEN3' as string message of up to 4 chars Display `LEN2' as string message of up to 4 chars Display `LEN1' as string message of up to 4 chars

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 111


This program will accept a string input of up to 6 characters, parse each character, and then display each character. Notice also that the values used for masking are represented in hexadecimal (as denoted by the preceding `$'). For more information, see section Sending Messages. To illustrate further, if the user types in the string "TESTME" at the input prompt, the controller will respond with the following:
T E S T M E Response from command MG LEN6 {S4} Response from command MG LEN5 {S4} Response from command MG LEN4 {S4} Response from command MG LEN3 {S4} Response from command MG LEN2 {S4} Response from command MG LEN1 {S4}

Functions
Function
@SIN[n] @COS[n] @TAN[n] @ASIN*[n] @ACOS* [n} @ATAN* [n] @COM[n] @ABS[n] @FRAC[n] @INT[n] @RND[n] @SQR[n] @IN[n] @OUT[n]

Description
Sine of n (n in degrees, with range of -32768 to 32767 and 16-bit fractional resolution) Cosine of n (n in degrees, with range of -32768 to 32767 and 16-bit fractional resolution) Tangent of n (n in degrees, with range of -32768 to 32767 and 16-bit fractional resolution) Arc Sine of n, between -90° and +90°. Angle resolution in 1/64000 degrees. Arc Cosine of n, between 0 and 180°. Angle resolution in 1/64000 degrees. Arc Tangent of n, between -90° and +90°. Angle resolution in 1/64000 degrees 1's Complement of n Absolute value of n Fraction portion of n Integer portion of n Round of n (Rounds up if the fractional part of n is .5 or greater) Square root of n (Accuracy is +/-.004) Return digital input at general input n (where n starts at 1) Return digital output at general output n (where n starts at 1)

* Note that these functions are multi-valued. An application program may be used to find the correct band. Functions may be combined with mathematical expressions. The order of execution of mathematical expressions is from left to right and can be over-ridden by using parentheses. Examples:
V1=@ABS[V7] V2=5*@SIN[POS] V3=@IN[1] The variable, V1, is equal to the absolute value of variable V7. The variable, V2, is equal to five times the sine of the variable, POS. The variable, V3, is equal to the digital value of input 1.

Variables
For applications that require a parameter that is variable, the DMC-14XX provides 126 variables. These variables can be numbers or strings. A program can be written in which certain parameters, such as position or speed, are defined as variables. The variables can later be assigned by the operator or determined by program calculations. For example, a cut-to-length application may require that a cut length be variable.

112 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


Example:
PR POSX JG RPMY*70 Assigns variable POSX to PR command Assigns variable RPMY multiplied by 70 to JG command.

Programmable Variables
The DMC-14XX allows the user to create up to 126 variables. Each variable is defined by a name which can be up to eight characters. The name must start with an alphabetic character, however, numbers are permitted in the rest of the name. Spaces are not permitted. Variable names should not be the same as DMC-14XX instructions. For example, PR is not a good choice for a variable name. Examples of valid and invalid variable names are: Valid Variable Names POSX POS1 SPEEDZ Invalid Variable Names REALLONGNAME 123 SPEED Z Assigning Values to Variables: Assigned values can be numbers, internal variables and keywords, functions, controller parameters and strings; The range for numeric variable values is 4 bytes of integer (231)followed by two bytes of fraction (+/-2,147,483,647.9999). Numeric values can be assigned to programmable variables using the equal sign. Any valid DMC-14XX function can be used to assign a value to a variable. For example, V1=@ABS[V2] or V2=@IN[1]. Arithmetic operations are also permitted. To assign a string value, the string must be in quotations. String variables can contain up to six characters which must be in quotation. Examples:
POSX=_TPX SPEED=5.75 INPUT=@IN[2] V2=V1+V3*V4 VAR="CAT" Assigns returned value from TPX command to variable POSX. Assigns value 5.75 to variable SPEED Assigns logical value of input 2 to variable INPUT Assigns the value of V1 plus V3 times V4 to the variable V2. Assign the string, CAT, to VAR

; Cannot have more than 8 characters ; Cannot begin variable name with a number ; Cannot have spaces in the name

Assigning Variable Values to Controller Parameters Variable values may be assigned to controller parameters such as PR or SP. PR V1 SP VS*2000 Assign V1 to PR command Assign VS*2000 to SP command

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 113


Displaying the value of variables at the terminal Variables may be sent to the screen using the format, variable=. For example, V1= , returns the value of the variable V1.

Operands
Operands allow motion or status parameters of the DMC-14XX to be incorporated into programmable variables and expressions. Most DMC-14XX commands have an equivalent operand - which are designated by adding an underscore (_) prior to the DMC-14XX command. The command reference indicates which commands have an associated operand. Status commands such as Tell Position return actual values, whereas action commands such as KP or SP return the values in the DMC-14XX registers. The axis designation is required following the command. Examples of Internal Variables:
POSX=_TPX VAR1=_KPX*2 JP #LOOP,_TEX>5 JP #ERROR,_TC=1 Assigns value from Tell Position X to the variable POSX. Assigns value from KPX multiplied by two to variable, VAR1. Jump to #LOOP if the position error of X is greater than 5 Jump to #ERROR if the error code equals 1.

Operands can be used in an expression and assigned to a programmable variable, but they cannot be assigned a value. For example: _KPX=2 is invalid.

Special Operands (Keywords)
The DMC-14XX provides a few additional operands which give access to internal variables that are not accessible by standard DMC-14XX commands. Operand
_BGn _BN _DA _DL _DM _HMn _LFn _LRX _UL TIME

Function
*Returns a 1 if motion on axis `n' is complete, otherwise returns 0. *Returns serial # of the board. *Returns the number of arrays available *Returns the number of available labels for programming *Returns the available array memory *Returns status of Home Switch (equals 0 or 1) Returns status of Forward Limit switch input of axis `n' (equals 0 or 1) Returns status of Reverse Limit switch input of axis `n' (equals 0 or 1) *Returns the number of available variables Free-Running Real Time Clock (off by 2.4% - Resets with power-on). Note: TIME does not use an underscore character (_) as other keywords.

·

- These keywords have corresponding commands while the keywords _LF, _LR, and TIME do not have any associated commands. All keywords are listed in the Command Reference manual.

Examples of Keywords:
V1=_LFX V3=TIME V4=_HMW Assign V1 the logical state of the Forward Limit Switch on the X-axis Assign V3 the current value of the time clock Assign V4 the logical state of the Home input on the W-axis

114 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


Arrays
For storing and collecting numerical data, the DMC-14XX provides array space for 2000 elements. The arrays are one dimensional and up to 14 different arrays may be defined. Each array element has a 31 numeric range of 4 bytes of integer (2 )followed by two bytes of fraction (+/-2,147,483,647.9999). Arrays can be used to capture real-time data, such as position, torque and analog input values. In the contouring mode, arrays are convenient for holding the points of a position trajectory in a record and playback application.

Defining Arrays
An array is defined with the command DM. The user must specify a name and the number of entries to be held in the array. An array name can contain up to eight characters, starting with an uppercase alphabetic character. The number of entries in the defined array is enclosed in [ ]. Example:
DM POSX[7] DM SPEED[100] DM POSX[0] Defines an array names POSX with seven entries Defines an array named speed with 100 entries Frees array space

Assignment of Array Entries
Like variables, each array element can be assigned a value. Assigned values can be numbers or returned values from instructions, functions and keywords. Array elements are addressed starting at count 0. For example the first element in the POSX array (defined with the DM command, DM POSX[7]) would be specified as POSX[0]. Values are assigned to array entries using the equal sign. Assignments are made one element at a time by specifying the element number with the associated array name. NOTE: Arrays must be defined using the command, DM, before assigning entry values. Examples:
DM SPEED[10] SPEED[1]=7650.2 SPEED[1]= POSX[10]=_TPX CON[2]=@COS[POS]*2 TIMER[1]=TIME Dimension Speed Array Assigns the first element of the array, SPEED the value 7650.2 Returns array element value Assigns the 11th element of the array POSX the returned value from the tell position command. Assigns the third element of the array CON the cosine of the variable POS multiplied by 2. Assigns the second element of the array timer the returned value of the TIME keyword.

Using a Variable to Address Array Elements An array element number can also be a variable. This allows array entries to be assigned sequentially using a counter. For example: Instruction
#A COUNT=0;DM POS[10] #LOOP WT 10

Interpretation
Begin Program Initialize counter and define array Begin loop Wait 10 msec

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 115


POS[COUNT]=_TPX POS[COUNT]= COUNT=COUNT+1 JP #LOOP,COUNT<10 EN

Record position into array element Report position Increment counter Loop until 10 elements have been stored End Program

The above example records 10 position values at a rate of one value per 10 msec. The values are stored in an array named POS. The variable, COUNT, is used to increment the array element counter. The above example can also be executed with the automatic data capture feature described below. Uploading and Downloading Arrays to On Board Memory Arrays may be uploaded and downloaded using the QU and QD commands. QU array[],start,end,delim QD array[],start,end where array is an array name such as A[]. Start is the first element of array (default=0) End is the last element of array (default=last element) Delim specifies whether the array data is separated by a comma (delim=1) or a carriage return (delim=0). The file is terminated using Z, Q, D or \.

Automatic Data Capture into Arrays
The DMC-14XX provides a sp error, inputs or torque. This is performance. Up to four types time interval may be specified. recording. ecial feature for automatic capture of data such as position, position useful for teaching motion trajectories or observing system of data can be captured and stored in four arrays. The capture rate or Recording can be done as a one time event or as a circular continuous

Command Summary - Automatic Data Capture Command
RA n[],m[],o[],p[] RD type1,type2,type3,type4

Description
Selects up to four arrays for data capture. The arrays must be defined with the DM command. Selects the type of data to be recorded, where type1, type2, type3, and type 4 represent the various types of data (see table below). The order of data type is important and corresponds with the order of n,m,o,p arrays in the RA command. The RC command begins data collection. Sets data capture time interval where n is an integer between 1 and 8 and designates 2n msec between data. m is optional and specifies the number of elements to be captured. If m is not defined, the number of elements defaults to the smallest array defined by DM. When m is a negative number, the recording is done continuously in a circular manner. _RD is the recording pointer and indicates the address of the next array element. n=0 stops recording. Returns a 0 or 1 where, 0 denotes not recording, 1 specifies recording in progress

RC n,m

RC?

116 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


Data Types for Recording: Data type
_DEX _TPX _TEX _SHX _RLX _TI _OP _TSX _SCX _NOX _TTX

Description
2nd encoder position (dual encoder) Encoder position Position error Commanded position Latched position Inputs Output Switches (only bit 0-4 valid) Stop code Status bits Torque

Note: X may be replaced by Y for capturing data on the other axis. Operand Summary - Automatic Data Capture
_RC _RD Returns a 0 or 1 where, 0 denotes not recording, 1 specifies recording in progress Returns address of next array element.

Example - Recording into An Array During a position move, store the X and Y positions and position error every 2 msec.
Instruction #RECORD DM XPOS[300],YPOS[300] DM XERR[300],YERR[300] RA XPOS[],XERR[],YPOS[],YERR[] RD _TPX,_TEX,_TPY,_TEY PR 10000,20000 RC1 BG XY #A;JP #A,RC=1 MG "DONE" EN #PLAY N=0 #DONE N= X POS[N]= Y POS[N]= XERR[N]= YERR[N]= N=N+1 JP# DONE,N<300 EN Interpretation Begin program Define X,Y position arrays Define X,Y error arrays Select arrays for capture Select data types Specify move distance Start recording now, at rate of 2 msec Begin motion Loop until done Print message End program Play back Initial Counter Done Print Counter Print X position Print Y position Print X error Print Y error Increment Counter Jump to #DONE as long as there are positions left End Program

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 117


Deallocating Array Space
Array space may be deallocated using the DA command followed by the array name. DA*[0] deallocates all the arrays.

Input of Data (Numeric and String)
Input of Data
The command, IN, is used to prompt the user to input numeric or string data. Using the IN command, the user may specify a message prompt by placing a message in quotations. When the controller executes an IN command, the controller will wait for the input of data. The input data is assigned to the specified variable or array element. Note: The IN command is only valid when communicating through RS232. This command will not work through the Ethernet. An Example for Inputting Numeric Data #A IN "Enter Length", LENX EN In this example, the message "Enter Length" is displayed on the computer screen. The controller waits for the operator to enter a value. The operator enters the numeric value which is assigned to the variable, LENX. Cut-to-Length Example In this example, a length of material is to be advanced a specified distance. When the motion is complete, a cutting head is activated to cut the material. The length is variable, and the operator is prompted to input it in inches. Motion starts with a start button which is connected to input 1. The load is coupled with a 2 pitch lead screw. A 2000 count/rev encoder is on the motor, resulting in a resolution of 4000 counts/inch. The program below uses the variable LEN, to length. The IN command is used to prompt the operator to enter the length, and the entered value is assigned to the variable LEN. Instruction
#BEGIN AC 800000 DC 800000 SP 5000 LEN=3.4 #CUT AI1 IN "enter Length(IN)", LEN PR LEN *4000 BGX AMX SB1

Interpretation
LABEL Acceleration Deceleration Speed Initial length in inches Cut routine Wait for start signal Prompt operator for length in inches Specify position in counts Begin motion to move material Wait for motion done Set output to cut

118 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


WT100;CB1 JP #CUT EN

Wait 100 msec, then turn off cutter Repeat process End program

Inputting String Variables String variables with up to six characters may input using the specifier, {Sn} where n represents the number of string characters to be input. If n is not specified, six characters will be accepted. For example, IN "Enter X,Y or Z", V{S} specifies a string variable to be input.

Output of Data (Numeric and String)
Numerical and string data can be output from the controller using several methods. The message command, MG, can output string and numerical data. Also, the controller can be commanded to return the values of variables and arrays, as well as other information using the interrogation commands (the interrogation commands are described in chapter 5).

Sending Messages
Messages may be sent to the bus using the message command, MG. This command sends specified text and numerical or string data from variables or arrays to the screen. Text strings are specified in quotes and variable or array data is designated by the name of the variable or array. For example: MG "The Final Value is", RESULT In addition to variables, functions and commands, responses can be used in the message command. For example: MG "The input is", @IN[1] MG "The proportional Gain of X is", _KPX Formatting Messages String variables can be formatted using the specifier, {Sn} where n is the number of characters, 1 thru 6. For example: MG STR {S3} This statement returns 3 characters of the string variable named STR. Numeric data may be formatted using the {Fn.m} expression following the completed MG statement. {$n.m} formats data in HEX instead of decimal. The actual numerical value will be formatted with n characters to the left of the decimal and m characters to the right of the decimal. Leading zeros will be used to display specified format. For example:: MG "The Final Value is", RESULT {F5.2} If the value of the variable RESULT is equal to 4.1, this statement returns the following: The Final Value is 00004.10 If the value of the variable RESULT is equal to 999999.999, the above message statement returns the following: The Final Value is 99999.99 The message command normally sends a carriage return and line feed following the statement. The carriage return and the line feed may be suppressed by sending {N} at the end of the statement. This is useful when a text string needs to surround a numeric value.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 119


Example: #A JG 50000;BGX;ASX MG "The Speed is", _TVX {F5.1} {N} {EA} MG "counts/sec" {EA} EN When #A is executed, the above example will appear on the screen (on handle A) as: The speed is 50000 counts/sec Summary of Message Functions: Function
"" {Fn.m} {$n.m} {^n} {N} {Sn} {Ex} {P}

Description
Surrounds text string Formats numeric values in decimal n digits to the right of the decimal point and m digits to the left Formats numeric values in hexadecimal Sends ASCII character specified by integer n Suppresses carriage return/line feed Sends the first n characters of a string variable, where n is 1 thru 6. For Ethernet and `x' specifies the Ethernet handle (A, B, C, D, E, F, or H) Directs output to serial port

Displaying Variables and Arrays
Variables and arrays may be sent to the screen using the format, variable= or array[x]=. For example, V1= , returns the value of V1. Example - Printing a Variable and an Array element Instruction Interpretation
#DISPLAY DM POSX[7] PR 1000 BGX AMX V1=_TPX POSX[1]=_TPX V1= Label Define Array POSX with 7 entries Position Command Begin After Motion Assign Variable V1 Assign the first entry Print V1

Interrogation Commands
The DMC-14XX has a set of commands that directly interrogate the controller. When these command are entered, the requested data is returned in decimal format on the next line followed by a carriage return and line feed. The format of the returned data can be changed using the Position Format (PF), and Leading Zeros (LZ) command. For a complete description of interrogation commands, see chapter 5.

120 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


Using the PF Command to Format Response from Interrogation Commands The command, PF, can change format of the values returned by theses interrogation commands:
BL ? DE ? DP ? EM ? FL ? IP ? TP LE ? PA ? PR ? TN ? VE ? TE

The numeric values may be formatted in decimal or hexadecimal* with a specified number of digits to the right and left of the decimal point using the PF command. Position Format is specified by: PF m.n where m is the number of digits to the left of the decimal point (0 thru 10) and n is the number of digits to the right of the decimal point (0 thru 4) A negative sign for m specifies hexadecimal format. Hex values are returned preceded by a $ and in 2's complement. Hex values should be input as signed 2's complement, where negative numbers have a negative sign. The default format is PF 10.0. If the number of decimal places specified by PF is less than the actual value, a nine appears in all the decimal places. Examples: Instruction
:DP21 :TPX 0000000021 :PF4 :TPX 0021 :PF-4 :TPX $0015 :PF2 :TPX 99

Interpretation
Define position Tell position Default format Change format to 4 places Tell position New format Change to hexadecimal format Tell Position Hexadecimal value Format 2 places Tell Position Returns 99 if position greater than 99

Removing Leading Zeros from Response to Interrogation Response The leading zeros on data returned as a response to interrogation commands can be removed by the use of the command, LZ. Example - Using the LZ command
LZ0 TP Disables the LZ function Tell Position Interrogation Command Response from Interrogation Command (With Leading Zeros) Enables the LZ function Tell Position Interrogation Command

-0000000009, 0000000005, 0000000000, 0000000007
LZ1 TP

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 121


-9, 5, 0, 7

Response from Interrogation Command (Without Leading Zeros)

Local Formatting of Response of Interrogation Commands The response of interrogation commands may be formatted locally. To format locally, use the command, {Fn.m} or {$n.m} on the same line as the interrogation command. The symbol F specifies that the response should be returned in decimal format and $ specifies hexadecimal. n is the number of digits to the left of the decimal, and m is the number of digits to the right of the decimal. For example: Examples:
TP {F2.2} -05.00, 05.00, 00.00, 07.00 TP {$4.2} FFFB.00,$0005.00,$0000.00,$0007.00 Tell Position in decimal format 2.2 Response from Interrogation Command Tell Position in hexadecimal format 4.2 Response from Interrogation Command

Formatting Variables and Array Elements
The Variable Format (VF) command is used to format variables and array elements. The VF command is specified by: VF m.n where m is the number of digits to the left of the decimal point (0 thru 10) and n is the number of digits to the right of the decimal point (0 thru 4). A negative sign for m specifies hexadecimal format. The default format for VF is VF 10.4 Hex values are returned preceded by a $ and in 2's complement.
:V1=10 :V1= 0000000010.0000 :VF2.2 :V1= 10.00 :VF-2.2 :V1= $0A.00 :VF1 :V1= 9 Assign V1 Return V1 Default format Change format Return V1 New format Specify hex format Return V1 Hex value Change format Return V1 Overflow

Local Formatting of Variables PF and VF commands are global format commands that effect the format of all relevant returned values and variables. Variables may also be formatted locally. To format locally, use the command, {Fn.m} or {$n.m} following the variable name and the `=' symbol. F specifies decimal and $ specifies hexadecimal. n is the number of digits to the left of the decimal, and m is the number of digits to the right of the decimal. For example: Examples:
:V1=10 :V1= 0000000010.0000 :V1={F4.2} Assign V1 Return V1 Default Format Specify local format

122 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


0010.00 :V1={$4.2} $000A.00 :V1="ALPHA" :V1={S4} ALPH

New format Specify hex format Hex value Assign string "ALPHA" to V1 Specify string format first 4 characters

The local format is also used with the MG* command.

Converting to User Units
Variables and arithmetic operations make it easy to input data in desired user units such as inches or RPM. The DMC-14XX position parameters such as PR, PA and VP have units of quadrature counts. Speed parameters such as SP, JG and VS have units of counts/sec. Acceleration parameters such as AC, DC, VA and VD have units of counts/sec2. The controller interprets time in milliseconds. All input parameters must be converted into these units. For example, an operator can be prompted to input a number in revolutions. A program could be used such that the input number is converted into counts by multiplying it by the number of counts/revolution. Example: Instruction
#RUN IN "ENTER # OF REVOLUTIONS",N1 PR N1*2000 IN "ENTER SPEED IN RPM",S1 SP S1*2000/60 AC A1*2000/(2*3.14) BG EN

Interpretation
Label Prompt for revs Convert to counts Prompt for RPMs Convert to counts/sec Convert to counts/sec^2 Begin motion End program

IN "ENTER ACCEL IN RAD/SEC2",A1 Prompt for ACCEL

Programmable Hardware I/O
Digital Outputs
The DMC-14XX has an 3-bit uncommitted output port for controlling external events. For example: Instruction
SB3 CB1

Interpretation
Sets bit 3 of output port Clears bit 1 of output port

The Output Bit (OB) instruction is useful for setting or clearing outputs depending on the value of a variable, array, input or expression. Any non-zero value results in a set bit. Instruction
OB1, POS OB 2, @IN [1]

Interpretation
Set Output 1 if the variable POS is non-zero. Clear Output 1 if POS equals 0. Set Output 2 if Input 1 is high. If Input 1 is low, clear Output 2.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 123


OB 3, @IN [1]&@IN [2] OB 2, COUNT [1]

Set Output 3 only if Input 1 and Input 2 are high. Set Output 2 if element 1 in the array COUNT is non-zero.

The output port can be set by specifying an 3-bit word using the instruction OP (Output Port). This instruction allows a single command to define the state of the entire 3-bit output port, where 20 is output 1, 21 is output 2 and so on. A 1 designates that the output is on. For example: Instruction
OP6 OP0 OP 7

Interpretation
Sets outputs 2 and 3 of output port to high. All other bits are 0. (21 + 22 = 6) Clears all bits of output port to zero Sets all bits of output port to one. (20 + 21 + 22 )

The output port is useful for setting relays or controlling external switches and events during a motion sequence. Example - Turn on output after move Instruction Interpretation
#OUTPUT PR 2000 BG AM SB1 WT 1000 CB1 EN Label Position Command Begin After move Set Output 1 Wait 1000 msec Clear Output 1 End

Digital Inputs
The DMC-1415 and DMC-1416 has seven digital inputs for controlling motion by local switches, while the DMC-1425 has 3 digital inputs. The @IN[n] function returns the logic level of the specified input 1 through 8. For example, a Jump on Condition instruction can be used to execute a sequence if a high condition is noted on an input 3. To halt program execution, the After Input (AI) instruction waits until the specified input has occurred. Example:
JP #A,@IN[1]=0 JP #B,@IN[2]=1 AI 7 AI -6 Jump to A if input 1 is low Jump to B if input 2 is high Wait until input 7 is high Wait until input 6 is low

Example - Start Motion on Switch Motor X must turn at 4000 counts/sec when the user flips a panel switch to on. When panel switch is turned to off position, motor X must stop turning. Solution: Connect panel switch to input 1 of DMC-14XX. High on input 1 means switch is in on position. Instruction Interpretation
#S;JG 4000 Set speed

124 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


AI 1;BGX AI -1;STX AMX;JP #S EN;

Begin after input 1 goes high Stop after input 1 goes low After motion, repeat

Input Interrupt Function
The DMC-14XX provides an input interrupt function which causes the program to automatically execute the instructions following the #ININT label. This function is enabled using the II m,n,o,p command. The m specifies the beginning input and n specifies the final input in the range. The parameter o is an integer that represents a binary range of inputs. For example if inputs 1 and 3 want to be used for the input interrupt function then the corresponding value of o is 20+22 or 5. The parameter p is similar to o except the inputs that are specified will activate the input interrupt routine when they go high instead of low. See the II command DMC-1400 Series command reference for details. A low input on any of the specified inputs will cause automatic execution of the #ININT subroutine. The Return from Interrupt (RI) command is used to return from this subroutine to the place in the program where the interrupt had occurred. If it is desired to return to somewhere else in the program after the execution of the #ININT subroutine, the Zero Stack (ZS) command is used followed by unconditional jump statements. IMPORTANT: Use the RI instruction (not EN) to return from the #ININT subroutine. Examples - Input Interrupt Instruction Interpretation
#A II 1 JG 30000,-20000 BG XY #B TP XY WT 1000 JP #B EN #ININT ST XY #LOOP;JP #LOOP,@IN[1]=0 JG 15000,10000 WT 300 BG XY RI Label #A Enable input 1 for interrupt function Set speeds on X and Y axes Begin motion on X and Y axes Label #B Report X and Y axes positions Wait 1000 milliseconds Jump to #B End of program Interrupt subroutine Stops motion on X and Y axes Loop until Interrupt cleared Specify new speeds Wait 300 milliseconds Begin motion on X and Y axes Return from Interrupt subroutine

MG "Interrupt has occurred" Displays the message

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 125


Example Applications
Wire Cutter
An operator activates a start switch. This causes a motor to advance the wire a distance of 10". When the motion stops, the controller generates an output signal which activates the cutter. Allowing 100 ms for the cutting completes the cycle. Suppose that the motor drives the wire by a roller with a 2" diameter. Also assume that the encoder resolution is 1000 lines per revolution. Since the circumference of the roller equals 2 inches, and it corresponds to 4000 quadrature, one inch of travel equals: 4000/2 = 637 count/inch This implies that a distance of 10 inches equals 6370 counts, and a slew speed of 5 inches per second, for example, equals 3185 count/sec. The input signal may be applied to I1, for example, and the output signal is chosen as output 1. The motor velocity profile and the related input and output signals are shown in Fig. 7.1. The program starts at a state that we define as #A. Here the controller waits for the input pulse on I1. As soon as the pulse is given, the controller starts the forward motion. Upon completion of the forward move, the controller outputs a pulse for 20 ms and then waits an additional 80 ms before returning to #A for a new cycle. Instruction Interpretation
#A AI1 PR 6370 SP 3185 BGX AMX SB1 WT 20 CB1 WT 80 JP #A Label Wait for input 1 Distance Speed Start Motion After motion is complete Set output bit 1 Wait 20 ms Clear output bit 1 Wait 80 ms Repeat the process

126 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


START PULSE I1

MOTOR VELOCITY

OUTPUT PULSE

output TIME INTERVALS move wait ready move Figure 7.1 - Motor Velocity and the Associated Input/Output signals

X-Y Table Controller
An X-Y system must cut the pattern shown in Fig. 7.2. The X-Y table moves the plate while digital output 1 raises and lowers the cutting tool. The solid curves in Fig. 7.2 indicate sections where cutting takes place. Those must be performed at a feedrate of 1 inch per second. The dashed line corresponds to non-cutting moves and should be performed at 5 inch per second. The acceleration rate is 0.1 g. The motion starts at point A, with the output bit off. An X-Y motion to point B is followed by setting an output bit to engage the cutting tool along the circle. Once the circular motion is completed, the output bit is cleared which raises the tool, and the motion continues to point C, etc. Assume that both of the axes are driven by lead screws with 10 turns-per-inch pitch. Also assume encoder resolution of 1000 lines per revolution. This results in the relationship: 1 inch = 40,000 counts and the speeds of 1 in/sec = 40,000 count/sec 5 in/sec = 200,000 count/sec an acceleration rate of 0.1g equals 0.1g = 38.6 in/s2 = 1,544,000 count/s2 Note that the circular path has a radius of 2" or 80000 counts, and the motion starts at the angle of 270° and traverses 360° in the CW (negative direction). Such a path is specified with the instruction CR 80000,270,-360

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 127


Instruction
#A OP0 VM XY VP 160000,160000 VE VS 200000 VA 1544000 BGS AMS SB1 WT1000 CR 80000,270,-360 VE VS 40000 BGS AMS CB1 WT1000 PR -21600 SP 20000 BGX AMX SB1 WT1000 CR 80000,270,-360 VE VS 40000 BGS AMS CB1 WT1000 VP -37600,-16000 VE VS 200000 BGS AMS EN

Interpretation
Label Set all output bits low Circular interpolation for XY Positions End Vector Motion Vector Speed Vector Acceleration Start Motion When motion is complete Set output bit to lower cutting tool Wait 1000msec for tool to be in cutting position Circle Feedrate Start circular move Wait for completion Clear output bit to raise cutting tool Wait 1000msec for tool to raise Move X Speed X Start X Wait for X completion Set output bit to lower cutting tool Wait 1000msec for tool to be in cutting position Second circle move

Clear output bit to raise cutting tool Wait 1000msec for tool to raise Return XY to start

128 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


Y

R=2

4 B C

A 0 4 9.3

X

Figure 7.2 - Motor Velocity and the Associated Input/Output signals

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 7 Application Programming i 129


THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK INTENTIONALLY

130 i Chapter 7 Application Programming

DMC-14x5/6


Chapter 8 Hardware & Software Protection

Introduction
The DMC-14XX provides several hardware and software features to check for error conditions and to inhibit the motor on error. These features help protect the system components from damage. WARNING: Machinery in motion can be dangerous! It is effective error handling and safety protection as part of the integral part of the machine, the engineer should design his possible component failure on the DMC-14XX. Galil shall incidental or consequential damages. the responsibility of the user to design machine. Since the DMC-14XX is an overall system with protection against a not be liable or responsible for any

Hardware Protection
The DMC-14XX includes hardware input and output protection lines for error and mechanical limit conditions. These include:

Output Protection Lines
Amp Enable - This signal goes low when the motor off command is given, when the position error exceeds the value specified by the Error Limit (ER) command, or when an off-on-error condition is enabled (OE1) and the abort command is given. Each axis amplifier has a separate enable line. This signal also goes low when the watch-dog timer is activated. Note: The standard configuration of the AEN signal is TTL active low. Both the polarity and the amplitude can be changed if you are using the ICM-1460 interface board. To make these changes, see section entitled `Amplifier Interface'. Note: There is only one amplifier enable signal for the DMC-1425. Therefore, both amplifiers will be controlled by the same enable output. Error Output - The error output is a TTL signal which indicates an error condition in the controller. This signal is available on the interconnect module as ERROR. When the error signal is low, this indicates one of the following error conditions: 1. 2. 3. 4. At least one axis has a position error greater than the error limit. The error limit is set by using the command ER. The reset line on the controller is held low or is being affected by noise. There is a failure on the controller and the processor is resetting itself. There is a failure with the output IC which drives the error signal.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 8 Hardware & Software Protection i 131


Input Protection Lines
Abort - A low input stops commanded motion instantly without a controlled deceleration. For any axis in which the Off-On-Error function is enabled, the amplifiers will be disabled. This could cause the motor to `coast' to a stop. If the Off-On-Error function is not enabled, the motor will instantaneously stop and servo at the current position. The Off-On-Error function is further discussed in this chapter. Forward Limit Switch - Low input inhibits motion in used to change the polarity of the limit switches.) If th the limit switch is activated, the motion will decelerate the forward direction, the controller will automatically (if such a routine has been written by the user). forward direction. (The e motor is moving in the and stop. In addition, if jump to the limit switch CN command can be forward direction when the motor is moving in subroutine, #LIMSWI

Reverse Limit Switch - Low input inhibits motion in reverse direction. (The CN command can be used to change the polarity of the limit switches.) If the motor is moving in the reverse direction when the limit switch is activated, the motion will decelerate and stop. In addition, if the motor is moving in the reverse direction, the controller will automatically jump to the limit switch subroutine, #LIMSWI (if such a routine has been written by the user).

Software Protection
The DMC-14XX provides a programmable error limit. The error limit refers to a difference in the actual and commanded position of the motor. This limit can be set for any number between 1 and 32767 using the ER n command. The default value for ER is 16384. Example:
ER 200,300 ER,1 Set X-axis error limit for 200, Y-axis error limit to 300 Set Y-axis error limit to 1 count.

The units of the error limit are quadrature counts. The error is the difference between the command position and actual encoder position. If the absolute value of the error exceeds the value specified by ER, the DMC-14XX will generate signals to warn the host system of the error condition. These signals include: Signal or Function
# POSERR Error Light OE Function AEN Output Line

State if Error Occurs
Jumps to automatic excess position error subroutine (if included in program) Turns on Shuts motor off if OE1 Goes low

The Jump if Condition statement is useful for branching within the program due to an error. The position error of X and Y can be monitored during execution using the TE command.

Programmable Position Limits
The DMC-14XX provides programmable forward and reverse position limits. These are set by the BL (Backwards Limit) and FL (Forward Limit) software commands. Once a position limit is specified, the DMC-14XX will not accept position commands beyond the limit. Motion beyond the limit is also prevented. Example:
DP0,0, BL -2000,-4000 FL 2000,4000 Define Position Set Reverse position limit Set Forward position limit

132 i Chapter 8 Hardware & Software Protection

DMC-14x5/6


JG 2000,2000 BG XY

Jog Begin

Execution of the above example will cause the motor to slew at the given jog speed until the forward position limit is reached. Motion will stop once the limit is hit.

Off-On-Error
The DMC-14XX controller has a built in function which can turn off the motors under certain error conditions. This function is know as `Off-On-Error". To activate the OE function for each axis, specify 1 for X and Y axes. To disable this function, specify 0 for the axes. When the function is enabled, the corresponding motor will be disabled under the following 3 conditions: 1. 2. 3. The position error for the specified axis exceeds the limit set with the command, ER The abort command is given The abort input is activated with a low signal.

Note: If the motors are disabled while they are moving, they may `coast' to a stop because they are no longer under servo control. To re-enable the system, use the Servo Here (SH) command. The SH command will clear any position error and reset the commanded position to the actual position. Examples:
OE 1,1 OE 0,1 Enable off-on-error for X and Y Enable off-on-error for Y axis and disable off-on-error for X axis

Automatic Error Routine
The #POSERR label causes the statements following to be automatically executed if the error on any axis exceeds the error limit specified by ER. The error routine should be closed with the RE command. RE will cause the main program to be resumed where left off. NOTE: The Error Subroutine will be entered again unless the error condition is gone. Example: Instruction
#A;JP #A;EN #POSERR MG "error" SB 1 STX AMX SHX RE

Interpretation
"Dummy" program Start error routine on error Send message Fire relay Stop motor After motor stops Servo motor here to clear error Return to main program

NOTE: An applications program must be executing for the #POSERR routine to function.

Limit Switch Routine
The DMC-14XX provides forward and reverse limit switches which inhibit motion in the respective direction. There is also a special label for automatic execution of a limit switch subroutine. The #LIMSWI label specifies the start of the limit switch subroutine. This label causes the statements

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 8 Hardware & Software Protection i 133


following to be automatically executed if any limit switch is activated. The RE command ends the subroutine and resumes the main program where it left off. The state of the forward and reverse limit switches may also be interrogated or used in a conditional statement. The _LR condition specifies the reverse limit and _LF specifies the forward limit. X or Y following _LR or _LF specifies the axis. The CN command can be used to configure the polarity of the limit switches. Limit Switch Example: Instruction
#A;JP #A;EN #LIMSWI V1=_LFX V2=_LRX JP#LF,V1=0 JP#LR,V2=0 JP#END #LF MG "FORWARD LIMIT" STX;AMX PR-1000;BGX;AMX JP#END #LR MG "REVERSE LIMIT" STX;AMX PR1000;BGX;AMX #END RE

Interpretation
Dummy Program Limit Switch Utility Check state of forward limit Check state of reverse limit Jump to #LF if forward limit = low Jump to #LR if reverse limit = low Jump to end #LF Send message Stop motion Move in reverse End #LR Send message Stop motion Move forward End Return to main program

NOTE: An applications program must be executing for #LIMSWI to function.

134 i Chapter 8 Hardware & Software Protection

DMC-14x5/6


Chapter 9 Troubleshooting

Overview
The following discussion may help you get your system running if a problem is encountered. Potential problems have been divided into groups as follows: 1. 2. 3. 4. Installation Communication Stability and Compensation Operation

The various symptoms along with the cause and the remedy are described in the following tables.

Installation
Symptom Motor runs away when connected to amplifier with no additional inputs. Same as above, but offset adjustment does not stop the motor. Controller does not read changes in encoder position. Same as above Same as above Cause Amplifier offset too large. Damaged amplifier. Wrong encoder connections. Bad encoder Bad controller Remedy Adjust amplifier offset Replace amplifier. Check encoder wiring. Check the encoder signals. Replace encoder if necessary. Connect the encoder to different axis input. If it works, controller failure. Repair or replace.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 9 Troubleshooting i 135


Communication
Symptom Using DMCWIN, DMCDOS, DMCTERM or WSDK cannot communicate with the controller over RS-232 Cause Improper settings, jumper configurations and/or cable type Remedy 1. Make sure that the baud rate set in the software corresponds to the baud rate set by the jumpers on the controller Make sure a straight-through RS-232 cable is used

2. Using DMCWIN, DMCTERM or WSDK cannot communicate with the controller over Ethernet IP address not assigned to controller, IP address not allowed in the internal LAN and/or improper Ethernet cable used

Follow the steps in Chapter for establishing an Ethernet connection

Stability
Symptom Motor runs away when the loop is closed. Cause Wrong feedback polarity. (Positive Feedback) Remedy Invert the polarity of the loop by inverting the motor leads (brush type) or the encoder (channel A+, B+ if single ended; channel A+, A- and B+, B- if differential) Decrease KI and KP. Increase KD.

Motor oscillates.

Too high gain or too little damping.

Operation
Symptom Controller rejects command. Responded with a ? Motor does not start or complete a move. Cause Anything. Noise on limit switches stops the motor. Noise on the abort line aborts the motion. Encoder noise Remedy Interrogate the cause with TC or TC1. To check the cause, interrogate the stop code (SC). If caused by limit switch or abort line noise, reduce noise. Interrogate the position periodically. If controller states that the position is the same at different locations it implies encoder noise. Also use a scope to see the noise. Reduce noise. Use differential encoder inputs. Avoid resetting position error at end of move with SH command.

During a periodic operation, motor drifts slowly.

Same as above.

Programming error.

136 i Chapter 9 Troubleshooting

DMC-14x5/6


Chapter 10 Theory of Operation

Overview
The following discussion covers the operation of motion control systems. A typical motion control system consists of the elements shown in Fig 10.1.

COMPUTER

CONTROLLER

DRIVER

ENCODER

MOTOR

Figure 10.1 - Elements of Servo Systems

The operation of such a system can be divided into three levels, as illustrated in Fig. 10.2. The levels are: 1. Closing the Loop 2. Motion Profiling 3. Motion Programming The first level, the closing of the loop, assures that the motor follows the commanded position. This is done by closing the position loop using a sensor. The operation at the basic level of closing the loop involves the subjects of modeling, analysis, and design. These subjects will be covered in the following discussions. The motion profiling is the generation of the desired position function. This function, R(t), describes where the motor should be at every sampling period. Note that the profiling and the closing of the loop are independent functions. The profiling function determines where the motor should be and the closing of the loop forces the motor to follow the commanded position

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 10 Theory of Operation i 137


The highest level of control is the motion program. This can be stored in the host computer or in the controller. This program describes the tasks in terms of the motors that need to be controlled, the distances and the speed.

LEVEL
3
MOTION PROGRAMMING

2

MOTION PROFILING

1

CLOSED-LOOP CONTROL

Figure 10.2 - Levels of Control Functions

The three levels of control may be viewed as different levels of management. The top manager, the motion program, may specify the following instruction, for example. PR 6000,4000 SP 20000,20000 AC 200000,00000 BG X AD 2000 BG Y EN This program corresponds to the velocity profiles shown in Fig. 10.3. Note that the profiled positions show where the motors must be at any instant of time. Finally, it remains up to the servo system to verify that the motor follows the profiled position by closing the servo loop. The following section explains the operation of the servo system. First, it is explained qualitatively, and then the explanation is repeated using analytical tools for those who are more theoretically inclined.

138 i Chapter 10 Theory of Operation

DMC-14x5/6


X VELOCITY

Y VELOCITY

X POSITION

Y POSITION

TIME

Figure 10.3 - Velocity and Position Profiles

Operation of Closed-Loop Systems
To understand the operation of a servo system, we may compare it to a familiar closed-loop operation, adjusting the water temperature in the shower. One control objective is to keep the temperature at a comfortable level, say 90 degrees F. To achieve that, our skin serves as a temperature sensor and reports to the brain (controller). The brain compares the actual temperature, which is called the feedback signal, with the desired level of 90 degrees F. The difference between the two levels is called the error signal. If the feedback temperature is too low, the error is positive, and it triggers an action which raises the water temperature until the temperature error is reduced sufficiently. The closing of the servo loop is very similar. Suppose that we want the motor position to be at 90 degrees. The motor position is measured by a position sensor, often an encoder, and the position feedback is sent to the controller. Like the brain, the controller determines the position error, which is the difference between the commanded position of 90 degrees and the position feedback. The controller then outputs a signal that is proportional to the position error. This signal produces a proportional current in the motor, which causes a motion until the error is reduced. Once the error becomes small, the resulting current will be too small to overcome the friction, causing the motor to stop. The analogy between adjusting the water temperature and closing the position loop carries further. We have all learned the hard way, that the hot water faucet should be turned at the "right" rate. If you turn it too slowly, the temperature response will be slow, causing discomfort. Such a slow reaction is called an overdamped response.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 10 Theory of Operation i 139


The results may be worse if we turn the faucet too fast. The overreaction results in temperature oscillations. When the response of the system oscillates, we say that the system is unstable. Clearly, unstable responses are bad when we want a constant level. What causes the oscillations? The basic cause for the instability is a combination of delayed reaction and high gain. In the case of the temperature control, the delay is due to the water flowing in the pipes. When the human reaction is too strong, the response becomes unstable. Servo systems also become unstable if their gain is too high. The delay in servo systems is between the application of the current and its effect on the position. Note that the current must be applied long enough to cause a significant effect on the velocity, and the velocity change must last long enough to cause a position change. This delay, when coupled with high gain, causes instability. This motion controller includes a special filter which is designed to help the stability and accuracy. Typically, such a filter produces, in addition to the proportional gain, damping and integrator. The combination of the three functions is referred to as a PID filter. The filter parameters are represented by the three constants KP, KI and KD, which correspond to the proportional, integral and derivative term respectively. The damping element of the filter acts as a predictor, thereby reducing the delay associated with the motor response. The integrator function, represented by the parameter KI, improves the system accuracy. With the KI parameter, the motor does not stop until it reaches the desired position exactly, regardless of the level of friction or opposing torque. The integrator also reduces the system stability. Therefore, it can be used only when the loop is stable and has a high gain. The output of the filter is applied to a digital-to-analog converter (DAC). The resulting output signal in the range between +10 and -10 Volts is then applied to the amplifier and the motor. The motor position, whether rotary or linear is measured by a sensor. The resulting signal, called position feedback, is returned to the controller for closing the loop. The following section describes the operation in a detailed mathematical form, including modeling, analysis and design.

System Modeling
The elements of a servo system include the motor, driver, encoder and the controller. These elements are shown in Fig. 10.4. The mathematical model of the various components is given below.

CONTROLLER
R


C

X

DIGITAL FILTER

Y

ZOH

DAC

V

AMP

E

MOTOR

P

ENCODER
Figure 10.4 - Functional Elements of a Motion Control System

140 i Chapter 10 Theory of Operation

DMC-14x5/6


Motor-Amplifier
The motor amplifier may be configured in three modes: 1. Voltage Drive 2. Current Drive 3. Velocity Loop The operation and modeling in the three modes is as follows: Voltage Drive The amplifier is a voltage source with a gain of Kv [V/V]. The transfer function relating the input voltage, V, to the motor position, P, is

PV=K
where

V

[
2 t

K t S ( STm + 1)( STe + 1)
[s]

]

Tm = RJ K
and

Te = L R
Kt R J L

[s]

and the motor parameters and units are
Torque constant [Nm/A] Armature Resistance Combined inertia of motor and load [kg.m2] Armature Inductance [H]

When the motor parameters are given in English units, it is necessary to convert the quantities to MKS units. For example, consider a motor with the parameters: Kt = 14.16 oz - in/A = 0.1 Nm/A R=2 J = 0.0283 oz-in-s2 = 2.10-4 kg . m2 L = 0.004H Then the corresponding time constants are Tm = 0.04 sec and Te = 0.002 sec Assuming that the amplifier gain is Kv = 4, the resulting transfer function is P/V = 40/[s(0.04s+1)(0.002s+1)] Current Drive The current drive generates a current I, which is proportional to the input voltage, V, with a gain of Ka. The resulting transfer function in this case is P/V = Ka Kt / Js2

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 10 Theory of Operation i 141


where Kt and J are as defined previously. For example, a current amplifier with Ka = 2 A/V with the motor described by the previous example will have the transfer function: P/V = 1000/s2 [rad/V]

If the motor is a DC brushless motor, it is driven by an amplifier that performs the commutation. The combined transfer function of motor amplifier combination is the same as that of a similar brush motor, as described by the previous equations. Velocity Loop The motor driver system may include a velocity loop where the motor velocity is sensed by a tachometer and is fed back to the amplifier. Such a system is illustrated in Fig. 10.5. Note that the transfer function between the input voltage V and the velocity is: /V = [Ka Kt/Js]/[1+Ka Kt Kg/Js] = 1/[Kg(sT1+1)] where the velocity time constant, T1, equals T1 = J/Ka Kt Kg This leads to the transfer function P/V = 1/[Kg s(sT1+1)]

V



Ka

Kt/Js

Kg

Figure 10.5 - Elements of velocity loops

The resulting functions derived above are illustrated by the block diagram of Fig. 10.6.

142 i Chapter 10 Theory of Operation

DMC-14x5/6


VOLTAGE SOURCE
V
Kv

E

1/Ke (STm+1)(STe+1)

W

1 S

P

CURRENT SOURCE
V
Ka

I

Kt JS

W

1 S

P

VELOCITY LOOP
V
1 Kg(ST1+1)

W

1 S

P

Figure 10.6 - Mathematical model of the motor and amplifier in three operational modes

Encoder
The encoder generates N pulses per revolution. It outputs two signals, Channel A and B, which are in quadrature. Due to the quadrature relationship between the encoder channels, the position resolution is increased to 4N quadrature counts/rev. The model of the encoder can be represented by a gain of Kf = 4N/2 Kf = 638 [count/rad]

For example, a 1000 lines/rev encoder is modeled as

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 10 Theory of Operation i 143


DAC
The DAC or D-to-A converter converts a 16-bit number to an analog voltage. The input range of the numbers is 65536 and the output voltage range is +/-10V or 20V. Therefore, the effective gain of the DAC is K= 20/65536 = 0.0003 [V/count]

Digital Filter
The digital filter has a transfer function of D(z) = [K(z-A)/z + Cz/(z-1)] and a sampling time of T. The filter parameters, K, A and C are selected by the instructions KP, KD and KI respectively. The relationship between the filter coefficients and the instructions are:
K = (KP + KD) C = KI/2



4

A = KD/(KP + KD)

This filter includes a lead compensation and an integrator. It is equivalent to a continuous PID filter with a transfer function G(s). G(s) = (P + sD + I/s) P = 4KP D = 4T KD I = KI/2T For example, if the filter parameters of the DMC-14XX are KP = 4 KD = 36 KI = 2 T = 0.001 s the digital filter coefficients are K = 160 A = 0.9 C=1 and the equivalent continuous filter, G(s), is G(s) = [16 + 0.144s + 1000/s}



ZOH
The ZOH, or zero-order-hold, represents the effect of the sampling process, where the motor command is updated once per sampling period. The effect of the ZOH can be modeled by the transfer function H(s) = 1/(1+sT/2) If the sampling period is T = 0.001, for example, H(s) becomes: H(s) = 2000/(s+2000) However, in most applications, H(s) may be approximated as one. This completes the modeling of the system elements. Next, we discuss the system analysis.

144 i Chapter 10 Theory of Operation

DMC-14x5/6


System Analysis
To analyze the system, we start with a block diagram model of the system elements. The analysis procedure is illustrated in terms of the following example. Consider a position control system with the DMC-14XX controller and the following parameters:
Kt = 0.1 J = 2.10-4 R=2 Ka = 4 KP = 12.5 KD = 245 KI = 0 N = 500 T=1 Counts/rev ms Nm/A kg.m2 Amp/Volt Torque constant System moment of inertia Motor resistance Current amplifier gain Digital filter gain Digital filter zero No integrator Encoder line density Sample period

The transfer function of the system elements are: Motor M(s) = P/I = Kt/Js2 = 500/s2 [rad/A] Amp Ka = 4 [Amp/V] DAC Kd = 0.0003 [V/count] Encoder Kf = 4N/2 = 318 [count/rad] ZOH 2000/(s+2000) Digital Filter KP = 12.5, KD = 245, T = 0.001 Therefore, D(z) = 1030 (z-0.95)/Z Accordingly, the coefficients of the continuous filter are: P = 50 D = 0.98 The filter equation may be written in the continuous equivalent form: G(s) = 50 + 0.98s = .098 (s+51) The system elements are shown in Fig. 10.7.

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 10 Theory of Operation i 145


FILTER V

ZOH 2000 S+2000

DAC 0.0003

AMP 4

MOTOR 500 S2



50+0.980s

ENCODER 318

Figure 10.7 - Mathematical model of the control system

The open loop transfer function, A(s), is the product of all the elements in the loop. A = 390,000 (s+51)/[s2(s+2000)] To analyze the system stability, determine the crossover frequency, c at which A(j c) equals one. This can be done by the Bode plot of A(j c), as shown in Fig. 10.8.

Magnitude

4 1 50 200 2000 W (rad/s)

0.1

Figure 10.8 - Bode plot of the open loop transfer function

For the given example, the crossover frequency was computed numerically resulting in 200 rad/s. Next, we determine the phase of A(s) at the crossover frequency. A(j200) = 390,000 (j200+51)/[(j200)2 . (j200 + 2000)] = Arg[A(j200)] = tan-1(200/51)-180° -tan-1(200/2000) = 76° - 180° - 6° = -110° Finally, the phase margin, PM, equals PM = 180° + = 70°

146 i Chapter 10 Theory of Operation

DMC-14x5/6


As long as PM is positive, the system is stable. However, for a well damped system, PM should be between 30 degrees and 45 degrees. The phase margin of 70 degrees given above indicated overdamped response. Next, we discuss the design of control systems.

System Design and Compensation
The closed-loop control system can be stabilized by a digital filter, which is preprogrammed in the DMC-14XX controller. The filter parameters can be selected by the user for the best compensation. The following discussion presents an analytical design method.

The Analytical Method
The analytical design method is aimed at closing the loop at a crossover frequency, c, with a phase margin PM. The system parameters are assumed known. The design procedure is best illustrated by a design example. Consider a system with the following parameters:
Kt J = 2.10-4 R=2 Ka = 2 N = 1000 Nm/A kg.m2 Amp/Volt Counts/rev Torque constant System moment of inertia Motor resistance Current amplifier gain Encoder line density

The DAC of the DMC-14XX outputs +/-10V for a 14-bit command of +/-8192 counts. The design objective is to select the filter parameters in order to close a position loop with a crossover frequency of c = 500 rad/s and a phase margin of 45 degrees. The first step is to develop a mathematical model of the system, as discussed in the previous system. Motor M(s) = P/I = Kt/Js2 = 1000/s2 Amp Ka = 2 DAC Kd = 10/32768 = .0003 Encoder Kf = 4N/2 = 636 ZOH H(s) = 2000/(s+2000) Compensation Filter G(s) = P + sD The next step is to combine all the system elements, with the exception of G(s), into one function, L(s). L(s) = M(s) Ka Kd Kf H(s) =3.17106/[s2(s+2000)] [Amp/V]

DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 10 Theory of Operation i 147


Then the open loop transfer function, A(s), is A(s) = L(s) G(s) Now, determine the magnitude and phase of L(s) at the frequency c = 500. L(j500) = 3.17106/[(j500)2 (j500+2000)] This function has a magnitude of |L(j500)| = 0.00625 and a phase Arg[L(j500)] = -180° - tan-1(500/2000) = -194° G(s) is selected so that A(s) has a crossover frequency of 500 rad/s and a phase margin of 45 degrees. This requires that |A(j500)| = 1 Arg [A(j500)] = -135° However, since A(s) = L(s) G(s) then it follows that G(s) must have magnitude of |G(j500)| = |A(j500)/L(j500)| = 160 and a phase arg [G(j500)] = arg [A(j500)] - arg [L(j500)] = -135° + 194° = 59° In other words, we need to select a filter function G(s) of the form G(s) = P + sD so that at the frequency c =500, the function would have a magnitude of 160 and a phase lead of 59 degrees. These requirements may be expressed as: |G(j500)| = |P + (j500D)| = 160 and arg [G(j500)] = tan-1[500D/P] = 59° The solution of these equations leads to: P = 160cos 59° = 82.4 500D = 160sin 59° = 137 Therefore, D = 0.274 and G = 82.4 + 0.2744s The function G is equivalent to a digital filter of the form: D(z) = 4KP + 4KD(1-z-1) where P = 4 KP

148 i Chapter 10 Theory of Operation

DMC-14x5/6


D = 4 KD T and 4 KD = D/T Assuming a sampling period of T=1ms, the parameters of the digital filter are: KP = 20.6 KD = 68.6 The DMC-14XX can be programmed with the instruction: KP 20.6 KD 68.6 In a similar manner, other filters can be programmed. The procedure is simplified by the following table, which summarizes the relationship between the various filters.

Equivalent Filter Form DMC-14XX Digital D(z) =K((z-A)/z) + Cz/(z-1) D(z) = 4 KP + 4 KD(1-z-1) + KI/2(1-z-1) K = (KP + KD) 4 A = KD/(KP+KD) C = KI/2 Continuous PID, T G(s) = (P + Ds + I/s) P = 4 KP D = 4 T*KD I = KI/2T

Digital KP, KD, KI,



DMC-14x5/6

Chapter 10 Theory of Operation i 149


THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK INTENTIONALLY

150 i Chapter 10 Theory of Operation

DMC-14x5/6


Appendices

Electrical Specifications
Servo Control
ACMD Amplifier Command: A+,A-,B+,B-,IDX+,IDX- Encoder and Auxiliary +/-10 Volts analog signal. Resolution 16-bit DAC or .0003 Volts. 3 mA maximum TTL compatible, but can accept up to +/-12 Volts. Quadrature phase on CHA,CHB. Can accept singleended (A+,B+ only) or differential (A+,A-,B+,B-). Maximum A,B edge rate: 12MHz. Minimum IDX pulse width: 80 nsec.

Stepper Control
Pulse Direction TTL (0-5 Volts) level at 50% duty cycle. 3MHz maximum step output frequency. TTL (0-5 Volts)

Input/Output
Uncommitted Inputs, Limits, Home, Abort Inputs: TTL Can accept up to +12V signal. OUT[1] thru OUT[3] Outputs: TTL.

Power Requirements
+5V +12V -12V 400 mA 40 mA* 40mA

DMC-14x5/6

Appendices i 151


*The +12V DC-to-DC converter on the DMC-1416 is maxed out at 40mA. Do not attempt to draw any more current out of the +12V pins +5V : .5A available -12v : 100mA available

Performance Specifications
Minimum Servo Loop Update Time: DMC-1415, 1425, 1416 Position Accuracy: Velocity Accuracy: Long Term Short Term Position Range: Velocity Range: Velocity Resolution: Motor Command Resolution: Variable Size: Variable Range: Variable Resolution: Array Size: Program Size: Phase-locked, better than .005% System dependent +/-2147483647 counts per move Up to 12,000,000 counts/sec servo; 3,000,000 pulses/sec-stepper 2 counts/sec 16 bit or 0.0003 V 126 user variables +/-2 billion 1 10-4 2000 elements, 14 arrays 500 lines x 80 characters Normal Firmware 250 sec +/-1 quadrature count Fast Firmware 125 µsec

Fast Update Rate Mode
The DMC-14x5/6 can operate with much faster servo update rates. This mode is known as 'fast mode' and allows the controller to operate with the following update rates: 1-2 axis 125 usec In order to run the motion controller in fast mode, the fast firmware must be uploaded. This can be done through the Galil terminal software such as Galil SmartTerminal and WSDK. The fast firmware can be downloaded from the Galil website. To set the update rate use command TM. When the controller is operating with the fast firmware, the following functions are disabled: Gearing mode Ecam mode

152 i Appendices

DMC-14x5/6


Stepper Motor Operation (MT 2,-2,2.5,-2.5) Trippoints in thread 2-8 Tell Velocity Interrogation Command (TV)

Connectors for DMC-14XX
J3 DMC-1415 General I/O; 37- PIN D-type (Female)
1 Reset
1

20 Error 21 ACMD (also PWM when JP3 jumpered) 22 Output 2 23 Circular Compare 24 Analog 2 25 Input 6 26 Input 4 27 Input 2
1 1 1 1 1 1

2 Amp Enable 3 Output 3 4 Output 1 5 Analog 1 6 Input 7 7 Input 5 8 Input 3
1 1 1

9 Input 1 (and latch) 10 + 5V 11 Ground 12 +12V 13 Ground 14 Main A15 Main B16 Main Index17 Auxiliary A 18 Auxiliary B -

28 Forward Limit 29 Reverse Limit 30 Home 31 ­12V 32 Main A+ 33 Main B+ 34 Main Index + 35 Auxiliary A + 36 Auxiliary B + 37 Abort
1 1

19 ACMD Phase B (also Sign when JP3 jumpered)
1

These inputs are TTL active low and will be activated when set to 0V.

J3 DMC-1425 General I/O; 37- PIN D-type (Female)
1 Reset
1

20 Error (Y step)4 21 ACMDX (X step) 22 Output 2 23 Circular Compare 24 Analog 2
4

2 Amp Enable (sign Y)4 3 Output 3 4 Output 1 5 Analog 1

DMC-14x5/6

Appendices i 153


6 Y Encoder Index + (Input 7) 7 Reverse Limit Y (Input 5)
1 1,2

1,2

25 Home Y (Input 6)

1,2 1,2

26 Forward Limit Y (Input 4) 27 Input 2 (and Y latch) 28 Forward Limit X 29 Reverse Limit X 30 Home X 31 -12v 32 X Encoder A+ 33 X Encoder B+ 34 X Encoder Index+ 35 Y Encoder A+ 36 Y Encoder B+ 37 Abort
1 1 1 1 1

8 Input 3 (Y Encoder Index-3) 9 Input 1 (and X latch) 10 + 5V 11 Ground 12 +12V 13 Ground 14 X Encoder A15 X Encoder B16 X Encoder Index17 Y Encoder A18 Y Encoder B19 ACMDY (sign X)
1 2
4

These inputs are TTL active low and will be activated when set to 0V. Pins 6, 7, 25 and 26 represent Index Y, Home Y, Reverse Limit Y and Forward Limit Y. The states of these inputs are mapped to inputs 7, 6, 5 and 4 respectively. Standard input interrogation commands can be used to read these inputs (TI, MG@IN[n]), as well as the TS and MG_LFY or MG_LRY switch commands. 3 Pin 8 has the option to be used as Y Encoder ­ instead of Input 3 4 When configured for stepper mode.

J3 DMC-1416 General I/O; 37- PIN D-type (Female)
1 Reset
2

20 Error 21 NC 22 Output 2 23 Circular Compare 24 Analog 2 25 Input 6 26 Input 4 27 Input 2
2 2 2 2 2 2

2 Amp Enable 3 Output 3 4 Output 1 5 Analog 1 6 Input 7 7 Input 5 8 Input 3
2 2 2

9 Input 1 (and latch) 10 + 5V 11 Ground 12 +12V 13 Ground 14 MA1

28 Forward Limit 29 Reverse Limit 30 Home 31 -12v 32 MA + 33 MB +
1 1 2

154 i Appendices

DMC-14x5/6


15 MB16 IDX-

1 1

34 IDX +

1

35 Auxiliary A + 36 Auxiliary B + 37 Abort

17 Auxiliary A 18 Auxiliary B 19 NC

If the controller is older than Rev C. These pins will have no connection. To add encoder signals in this case, contact Galil.
2

1

These inputs are active low and will be activated when set to 0V.

J4 DMC-1416 Encoders; 15-Pin D-type
1 A+ 2 GROUND 3 A4 B5 I6 HALL 1 7 HALL 3 8 NC 9 VCC 10 NC 11 A+ 12 B+ 13 I+ 14 HALL 2 15 GROUND

J5 DMC-1416 Power; 5-Pin MOLEX; Brushless Config. (Standard Servo)
1 MOTOR A (Motor +) 2 MOTOR B (Motor -) 3 MOTOR C (Ground) 4 GROUND 5 V+ INPUT

J1 RS232 Main port: DB-9 Pin Male:
1 RTS 2 Transmit data-output 3 Receive Data-input 4 CTS 5 Ground 6 RTS 7 CTS 8 RTS 9 No connect

DMC-14x5/6

Appendices i 155


Pin-Out Description
OUTPUTS Analog Motor Command +/- 10 Volt range signal for driving amplifier. In servo mode, motor command output is updated at the controller sample rate. In the motor off mode, this output is held at the OF command level. Amp Enable PWM/STEP OUT Signal to disable and enable an amplifier. Amp Enable goes low on Abort and OE1. PWM/STEP OUT is used for directly driving power bridges for DC servo motors or for driving step motor amplifiers. For servo motors: If you are using a conventional amplifier that accepts a +/-10 Volt analog signal, this pin is not used and should be left open. The PWM output is available in two formats: Inverter and Sign Magnitude. In the Inverter mode, the PWM signal is .2% duty cycle for full negative voltage, 50% for 0 Voltage and 99.8% for full positive voltage (24kHz switching frequency). In the Sign Magnitude Mode (Jumper SM), the PWM signal is 0% for 0 Voltage, 99.6% for full voltage and the sign of the Motor Command is available at the sign output (50kHz switching frequency). PWM/STEP OUT For step motors: The STEP OUT pin produces a series of pulses for input to a step motor driver. The pulses may either be low or high. The pulse width is 50%. Upon Reset, the output will be low if the SM jumper is on. If the SM jumper is not on, the output will be tristate. Used with PWM signal to give the sign of the motor command for servo amplifiers or direction for step motors. The signal goes low when the position error on any axis exceeds the value specified by the error limit command, ER. These 3 TTL outputs are uncommitted and may be designated by the user to toggle relays and trigger external events. The output lines are toggled by Set Bit, SB, and Clear Bit, CB, instructions. The OP instruction is used to define the state of all the bits of the Output port.

Sign/Direction Error Output 1-Output 3

INPUTS Main Encoder, A+, B+ Position feedback from incremental encoder with two channels in quadrature, CHA and CHB. The encoder may be analog or TTL. Any resolution encoder may be used as long as the maximum frequency does not exceed 12,000,000 quadrature states/sec. The controller performs quadrature decoding of the encoder signals resulting in a resolution of quadrature counts (4 x encoder cycles). Note: Encoders that produce outputs in the format of pulses and direction may also be used by inputting the pulses into CHA and direction into Channel B and using the CE command to configure this mode. Once-Per-Revolution encoder pulse. Used in Homing sequence or Find Index command to define home on an encoder index. Differential inputs from encoder. May be input along with CHA, CHB for noise immunity of encoder signals. The CHA- and CHB- inputs are optional.

Main Encoder Index, I+ Main Encoder, A-, B-, I-

Aux Encoder, A+, B+, A- Inputs for additional encoder. Used when an encoder on both the motor and the load , Bis required. Not available on DMC-1425. Abort input A low input stops commanded motion instantly without a controlled deceleration. Also aborts motion program.

156 i Appendices

DMC-14x5/6


Reset input

A low input resets the state of the processor to its power-on condition. The previously saved state of the controller, along with parameter values, and saved sequences are restored. When active, inhibits motion in forward direction. Also causes execution of limit switch subroutine, #LIMSWI. The polarity of the limit switch may be set with the CN command. When active, inhibits motion in reverse direction. Also causes execution of limit switch subroutine, #LIMSWI. The polarity of the limit switch may be set with the CN command. Input for Homing (HM) and Find Edge (FE) instructions. Upon BG following HM or FE, the motor accelerates to slew speed. A transition on this input will cause the motor to decelerate to a stop. The polarity of the Home Switch may be set with the CN command. Uncommitted inputs. May be defined by the user to trigger events. Inputs are checked with the Conditional Jump instruction and After Input instruction or Input Interrupt. Input 1 is used for the high-speed latch. Only 3 inputs for the DMC-1425. High speed position latch to capture axis position in less than 1 µsec on occurrence of latch signal. AL command arms latch. Input 1 is latch for X axis. Input 2 is latch for Y axis if using DMC-1425 12 bit resolution

Forward Limit Switch

Reverse Limit Switch

Home Switch

Input 1 - Input 7

Latch input

Analog input

ICM-1460 Interconnect Module
The ICM-1460, Rev C Interconnect Module provides easy connections between the DMC-14XX series controllers and other system elements, such as amplifiers, encoders, and external switches. The ICM1460 accepts the 37-pin cable from the DMC-1415, DMC-1425 or DMC-1416 and breaks the pins out to screw-type terminals. Each screw terminal is labeled for quick connection of system elements. The ICM-1460 is packaged as a circuit board mounted to a metal enclosure. A version of the ICM1460 is also available with a servo amplifier (see AMP-1460). Features · Breaks out 37-pin ribbon cable into individual screw-type terminals. · Clearly identifies all terminals · Available with on-board servo drive (see AMP-1460). · 10-pin IDC connectors for main encoder. Specifications
Rev A-F Terminal# 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Rev G Terminal # 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Label I/O Description

+12V4 -12V
4

O O O O O O --

+12 Volts -12 Volts Amplifier enable X axis or Y Axis Sign Output for Stepper X Axis Motor command or Pulse Output for Stepper Analog Input 1 Analog Input 2 Signal Ground

AMPEN/SIGNY5 ACMDX/PULSE(X) AN1 AI2 GND

DMC-14x5/6

Appendices i 157


8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 8 39 40

8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40

RESET ERROR/PULSE(Y) OUT3 OUT2 OUT1 CMP/ICOM 5V GND IN7/INDY+ IN6/HOMY IN5/RLSY IN4/FLSY IN3/IDYIN2 IN1/LTCH FLSX RLSX HOMX ABORT GND MA+ MAMB+ MBIDX+ IDXAA+ AAAB+ ABACMD2/SIGNX 5V GND
7 6

I O O O O O O -I I I I I I I I I I I -I I I I I I I I I I O O --

Reset Error signal or Y Axis Pulse Output for Stepper Output 3 Output 2 Output 1 Circular Compare / Input common for Opto option + 5 Volts Signal Ground Input 7 (Y Axis Main Encoder Index + for DMC-1425) Input 6 (Y Axis Home input for DMC-1425) Input 5 (Y axis reverse limit on DMC-1425) Input 4 (Y axis forward limit on DMC-1425) Input 3 (Y axis main encoder index for DMC-1425) Input 2 Input 1 / Input for Latch Function Forward limit switch input Reverse limit switch input Home input Abort Input Signal Ground X Axis Main Encoder A+ X Axis Main Encoder AX Axis Main Encoder B+ X Axis Main Encoder B5 5 5 5 5 5

X Axis Main Encoder Index + X Axis Main Encoder Index ­

X Axis Auxiliary Encoder A+ (Y Axis Main Encoder A+ for DMC1425) X Axis Auxiliary Encoder A- (Y Axis Main Encoder A- for DMC1425) X Axis Auxiliary Encoder B+ (Y Axis Main Encoder B+ for DMC1425) X Axis Auxiliary Encoder B- (Y Axis Main Encoder B- for DMC1425) 2nd Motor command Signal for Sine Amplifier or SIGNX for stepper + 5 Volts Signal Ground

4 The screw terminals for +/-12V can be configured as opto-input/output common. See next section for detail. 5 The screw terminal for amplifier enable output can be configured as the stepper motor direction output for Y axis for DMC1425 controller. 6 The error ouput is the pulse Y when Y is configured for stepper output. Note: Red LED will always be on when Y is in stepper mode.

158 i Appendices

DMC-14x5/6


7 The screw terminal for CMP can be configured as input/output common for opto-isolated I/O. Please see next section for detail.

Opto-Isolation Option for ICM-1460 (rev F and above)
The ICM-1460 module from Galil has an option for opto-isolated inputs and outputs. Any of the following pins can be chosen to be the input/output common: pin 1 (labeled as +12V), pin 2 (labeled as ­12V) and pin 13 (labeled as CMP/ICOM). When pin 1 is used as input/output common, the +12V output be comes inaccessible, when pin 2 is used, the ­12V becomes inaccessible, and when pin13 is used, the output compare function is not available. The common point need to be specified at the time of ordering. The ICM-1460 can also be configured so that the opto common is jumped with Vcc (+5V), in this case, no screw connections is needed, and the internal 5V will be used for powering the input/output. Option for separate input/output commons is also available, this will require the use of both pin 1 and pin 2 on the screw connection. When selecting this option, both +12V and ­12V becomes inaccessible.

ICM-1460 CONNECTIONS
OPTO-COMMON

TO CONTROLLER
VCC

RP2 / RP4 = 2.2K

RP3 / RP1 = 4.7K OHMS IN[x] (To controller)

IN[x]

Figure A-1 ­ Opto-isolated Inputs The signal "IN[x]" is one of the isolated digital outputs where x stands for the digital input terminals. The OPTO COMMON point should be connected to an isolated power supply in order to obtain isolation from the controller. By connecting the OPTO-COMMON to the + side of the power supply, the inputs will be activated by sinking current. By connecting the OPTO-COMMON to the GND side of the power supply, the inputs will be activated by sourcing current. The opto-isolation circuit requires 1ma drive current with approximately 400 sec response time. The voltage should not exceed 24V without placing additional resistance to limit the current to 11 ma.

DMC-14x5/6

Appendices i 159


Figure A-2 ­ Opto-isolated Outputs The signal "OUT[x]" is one of the isolated digital outputs where x stands for the digital output terminals. The OPTO-COMMON needs to be connected to an isolated power supply. The OUT[x] can be used to source current from the power supply. The maximum sourcing current for the OUT[x] is 25 ma. Sinking configuration can also be specified. Please contact Galil for detail. When opto-isolated outputs are used, either a pull-up or pull-down resistor needs to be provided by the user depending upon whether the signal is sinking or sourcing.

64 Extended I/O of the DMC-1415/1416/1425 Controller
The DMC-1415/1416/1425 controller offers 64 extended I/O points, which can be interfaced to Grayhill and OPTO-22 I/O mounting racks. These I/O points can be configured as inputs or outputs in 8 bit increments through software. The I/O points are accessed through two 50-pin IDC connectors, each with 32 I/O points.

Configuring the I/O of the DMC-1415/1416/1425 with DB-14064
The 64 extended I/O points of the DMC-1415/1416/1425 series controller with the DB-14064 daughter board module can be configured in blocks of 8. The extended I/O is denoted as blocks 2-9 or bits 1780. The command, CO, is used to configure the extended I/O as inputs or outputs. The CO command has one field: CO n Where, n is a decimal value, which represents a binary number. Each bit of the binary number represents one block of extended I/O. When set to 1, the corresponding block is configured as an output.

160 i Appendices

DMC-14x5/6


The least significant bit represents block 2 and the most significant bit represents block 9. The decimal value can be calculated by the following formula. n = n2 + 2*n3 + 4*n4 + 8*n5 +16* n6 +32* n7 +64* n8 +128* n9 where nx represents the block. If the nx value is a one, then the block of 8 I/O points is to be configured as an output. If the nx value is a zero, then the block of 8 I/O points will be configured as an input. For example, if block 4 and 5 is to be configured as an output, CO 12 is issued.
8-Bit I/O Block 17-24
25-32 33-40 41-48 49-56 57-64 65-72 73-80

Block 2
3 4 5 6 7 8 9

Binary Representation
2 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

Decimal Value for Block 1
2 4 8 16 32 64 128

2 2 2 2 2 2 2

The simplest method for determining n: Step 1. Determine which 8-bit I/O blocks to be configured as outputs. Step 2. From the table, determine the decimal value for each I/O block to be set as an output. Step 3. Add up all of the values determined in step 2. This is the value to be used for n. For example, if blocks 2 and 3 are to be outputs, then n is 3 and the command, CO3, should be issued. Note: This calculation is identical to the formula: n = n2 + 2*n3 + 4*n4 + 8*n5 +16* n6 +32* n7 +64* n8 +128* n9 where nx represents the block. Saving the State of the Outputs in Non-Volatile Memory The configuration of the extended I/O and the state of the outputs can be stored in the EEPROM with the BN command. If no value has been set, the default of CO 0 is used (all blocks are inputs). Accessing extended I/O When configured as an output, each I/O point may be defined with the SBn and CBn commands (where n=1 through 8 and 17 through 80). Outputs may also be defined with the conditional command, OBn (where n=1 through 8 and 17 through 80). The command, OP, may also be used to set output bits, specified as blocks of data. The OP command accepts 5 parameters. The first parameter sets the values of the main output port of the controller (Outputs 1-8, block 0). The additional parameters set the value of the extended I/O as outlined: OP m,a,b,c,d where m is the decimal representation of the bits 1-8 (values from 0 to 255) and a,b,c,d represent the extended I/O in consecutive groups of 16 bits. (values from 0 to 65535). Arguments which are given for I/O points which are configured as inputs will be ignored. The following table describes the arguments used to set the state of outputs.

DMC-14x5/6

Appendices i 161


Argument m a b c d

Blocks 0 2,3 4,5 6,7 8,9

Bits 1-8 17-32 33-48 49-64 65-80

Description General Outputs Extended I/O Extended I/O Extended I/O Extended I/O

For example, if block 8 is configured as an output, the following command may be issued: OP 7,,,,7 This command will set bits 1,2,3 (block 0) and bits 65,66,67 (block 8) to 1. Bits 4 through 8 and bits 68 through 80 will be set to 0. All other bits are unaffected. When accessing I/O blocks configured as inputs, use the TIn command. The argument 'n' refers to the block to be read (n=0,2,3,4,5,6,7,8 or 9). The value returned will be a decimal representation of the corresponding bits. Individual bits can be queried using the @IN[n] function (where n=1 through 8 or 17 through 80). If the following command is issued; MG @IN[17] the controller will return the state of the least significant bit of block 2 (assuming block 2 is configured as an input).

Connector Description:
The DB-14064 has two 50 Pin IDC header connectors. The connectors are compatible with I/O mounting racks such as Grayhill 70GRCM32-HL and OPTO-22 G4PB24. Note for interfacing to OPTO-22 G4PB24: When using the OPTO-22 G4PB24 I/O mounting rack, the user will only have access to 48 of the 64 I/O points available on the controller. Block 5 and Block 9 must be configured as inputs and will be grounded by the I/O rack. J6 50-PIN IDC
Pin Signal Block

1. 3. 5 7. 9. 11. 13. 15. 17. 19. 21. 23. 25. 27. 29. 31. 33. 35. 37. 39. 41.

I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I

/ / / / / / / / / / / / / / / / / / / / /

O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O

4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2

Bit @IN[n], @OUT[n] 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20

Bit No

7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 5 4 3

162 i Appendices

DMC-14x5/6


43. 45. 47. 49. 2. 4. 6. 8. 10. 12. 14. 16. 18. 20. 22. 24. 26. 28. 30. 32. 34. 36. 38. 40. 42. 44. 46. 48. 50.

I/O I/O I/O +5V I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND

2 2 2 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 -

19 18 17 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 -

2 1 0 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 -

J8 50-PIN IDC Pin

Signal

Block

1. 3. 5 7. 9. 11. 13. 15. 17. 19. 21. 23. 25. 27. 29. 31. 33. 35. 37. 39. 41. 43. 45. 47. 49. 2. 4. 6.

I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O +5V I/O I/O I/O

8 8 8 8 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 9 9 9

Bit @IN[n], @OUT[n] 72 71 70 69 68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 80 79 78

Bit No

7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 7 6 5

DMC-14x5/6

Appendices i 163


8. 10. 12. 14. 16. 18. 20. 22. 24. 26. 28. 30. 32. 34. 36. 38. 40. 42. 44. 46. 48. 50.

I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND GND

9 9 9 9 9 -

77 76 75 74 73 -

4 3 2 1 0 -

IOM-1964 Opto-Isolation Module for Extended I/O Controllers
Description:
· · · · · · · · Provides 64 optically isolated inputs and outputs, each rated for 2mA at up to 28 VDC Configurable as inputs or outputs in groups of eight bits Provides 16 high power outputs capable of up to 500mA each Connects to controller via 80 pin shielded cable All I/O points conveniently labeled Each of the 64 I/O points has status LED Dimensions 6.8" x 11.4" Works with extended I/O controllers

164 i Appendices

DMC-14x5/6


High Current Buffer chips (16)

Screw Terminals

01234567
IOM-1964 REV B GALIL MOTION CONTROL MADE IN USA FOR INPUTS: UX3 UX4 RPX4 FOR OUTPUTS: UX1 UX2 RPX2 RPX3

J5

Banks 0 and 1 provide high power output capability.

80 pin high density connector

Banks 2-7 are standard banks.

Figure A-3 ­ IOM-1964

Overview
The IOM-1964 is an input/output module that connects to the DB-14064 extended I/O daughter board cards from Galil, providing optically isolated buffers for the extended inputs and outputs of the controller. The IOM-1964 also provides 16 high power outputs capable of 500mA of current per output point. The IOM-1964 splits the 64 I/O points into eight banks of eight I/O points each, corresponding to the eight banks of extended I/O on the controller. Each bank is individually configured as an input or output bank by inserting the appropriate integrated circuits and resistor packs. The hardware configuration of the IOM-1964 must match the software configuration of the controller card. All DMC-1415/1416/1425 controllers have general purpose I/O connections. On the DMC-1415 and DMC-1416 there are 7 TTL inputs and 3 TTL outputs. On the DMC-1425 there are 3 TTL inputs and 3 TTL outputs The DMC-1415/1416/1425 and DB-14064, however, has an additional The 64 I/O points on the DB-14064 are attached via two 50 pin ribbon CB-50-80 adapter card is used to connect the two 50 pin ribbon cables connector. A 80 pin shielded cable connects from the 80 pin connector pin high density connector J5 on the IOM-1964. 64 digital input/output points. cable header connectors. A to a 80 pin high density of the CB-50-80 board to the 80

DMC-14x5/6

Appendices i 165


Configuring Hardware Banks
The extended I/O on the DMC-1415/1416/1425 and DB-14064 is configured using the CO command. The banks of buffers on the IOM-1964 are configured to match by inserting the appropriate IC's and resistor packs. The layout of each of the I/O banks is identical. For example, here is the layout of bank 0:
Resistor Pack for outputs

RP03 OUT
Resistor Pack for inputs

RP04 IN

U03

U04

Input Buffer IC's

IN
Resistor Pack for outputs

U01

U02

Output Buffer IC's

Figure A-4 ­ Bank 0 Layout All of the banks have the same configuration pattern as diagrammed above. For example, all banks have Ux1 and Ux2 output optical isolator IC sockets, labeled in bank 0 as U01 and U02, in bank 1 as U11 and U12, and so on. Each bank is configured as inputs or outputs by inserting optical isolator IC's and resistor packs in the appropriate sockets. A group of eight LED's indicates the status of each I/O point. The numbers above the Bank 0 label indicate the number of the I/O point corresponding to the LED above it.

Digital Inputs
Configuring a bank for inputs requires that the Ux3 and Ux4 sockets be populated with NEC2505 optical isolation integrated circuits. The IOM-1964 is shipped with a default configuration of banks 27 configured as inputs. The output IC sockets Ux1 and Ux2 must be empty. The input IC's are labeled Ux3 and Ux4. For example, in bank 0 the IC's are U03 and U04, bank 1 input IC's are labeled U13

166 i Appendices

OUT 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24

RP02 OUT D0 C6 RP01

OUT
Indicator LED's

Resistor Pack for LED's

Bank 0

DMC-14x5/6


and U14, and so on. Also, the resistor pack RPx4 must be inserted into the bank to finish the input configuration.
I/OCn

1/4 NEC2505 To DMC-14XX* I/O

1/8 RPx4 x = bank number 0-7 n = input number 17-80

DMC-14XX* GND I/On

Figure A-5 ­ Input Circuit Connections to this optically isolated input circuit are done in a sinking or sourcing configuration, referring to the direction of current. Some example circuits are shown below:
Sinking I/OCn I/O +5V I/OCn I/O Sourcing GND

n

GND
Current

n

+5V
Current

Figure A-6 ­ Optically Isolated Inputs Connected to Switches There is one I/OC connection for each bank of eight inputs. Whether the input is connected as sinking or sourcing, when the switch is open no current flows and the digital input function @IN[n] returns 1. This is because of an internal pull up resistor on the DMC-14XX/DB-14064*. When the switch is closed in either circuit, current flows. This pulls the input on the DMC-14XX/DB-14064 to ground, and the digital input function @IN[n] returns 0. Note that the external +5V in the circuits above is for example only. The inputs are optically isolated and can accept a range of input voltages from 4 to 28 VDC. Active outputs are connected to the optically isolated inputs in a similar fashion with respect to current. An NPN output is connected in a sinking configuration, and a PNP output is connected in the sourcing configuration.
Sinking I/OCn I/O
n

Sourcing +5V NPN output I/OCn I/O
n

GND PNP output

Current

Current

Figure A-7 ­ Optically Isolated Inputs Connected to Transistor Outputs Whether connected in a sinking or sourcing circuit, only two connections are needed in each case. When the NPN output is 5 volts, then no current flows and the input reads 1. When the NPN output goes to 0 volts, then it sinks current and the input reads 0. The PNP output works in a similar fashion, but the voltages are reversed i.e. 5 volts on the PNP output sources current into the digital input and the input reads 0. As before, the 5 volt is an example, the I/OC can accept between 4-28 volts DC.

DMC-14x5/6

Appendices i 167


Note that the current through the digital input should be kept below 3 mA in order to minimize the power dissipated in the resistor pack. This will help prevent circuit failures. The resistor pack RPx4 is standard 1.5k ohm that is suitable for power supply voltages up to 5.5 VDC. However, use of 24 VDC for example would require a higher resistance such as a 10k ohm resistor pack.

High Power Digital Outputs
The first two banks on the IOM-1964, banks 0 and 1, have high current output drive capability. The IOM-1964 is shipped with banks 0 and 1 configured as outputs. Each output can drive up to 500mA of continuous current. Configuring a bank of I/O as outputs is done by inserting the optical isolator NEC2505 IC's into the Ux1 and Ux2 sockets. The digital input IC's Ux3 and Ux4 are removed. The resistor packs RPx2 and RPx3 are inserted, and the input resistor pack RPx4 is removed. Each bank of eight outputs shares one I/OC connection, which is connected to a DC power supply between 4 and 28 VDC. A 10k ohm resistor pack should be used for RPx3. Here is a circuit diagram:
I/OCn To Controller +5V 1/8 RPx2 1/4 NEC2505 IR6210 VCC IN Controller I/O OUT GND 1/8 RPx3 I/On OUTCn PW ROUTn

Figure A-8 ­ IOM-1964 High Power Digital Output The load is connected between the power output and output common. The I/O connection is for test purposes, and would not normally be connected. An external power supply is connected to the I/OC and OUTC terminals, which isolates the circuitry of the DMC-14XX controller/DB-14064 daughter board from the output circuit.
I/OCn PWROUTn L o a d External Isolated Power Supply GNDISO

VISO

OUTCn

Figure A-9 - IOM-1964 High Power Output Load and Power Supply Connections

168 i Appendices

Current

DMC-14x5/6


The power outputs must be connected in a driving configuration as shown on the previous page. Here are the voltage outputs to expect after the Clear Bit and Set Bit commands are given: Output Command CBn SBn Result Vpwr = V
iso

Vpwr = GNDiso

Standard Digital Outputs
The I/O banks 2-7 can be configured as optically isolated digital outputs, however these banks do not have the high power capacity as in banks 0-1. In order to configure a bank as outputs, the optical isolator chips Ux1 and Ux2 are inserted, and the digital input isolator chips Ux3 and Ux4 are removed. The resistor packs RPx2 and RPx3 are inserted, and the input resistor pack RPx4 is removed. Each bank of eight outputs shares one I/OC connection, which is connected to a DC power supply between 4 and 28 VDC. The resistor pack RPx3 is optional, used either as a pull up resistor from the output transistor's collector to the external supply connected to I/OC or the RPx3 is removed resulting in an open collector output. Here is a schematic of the digital output circuit:
I/OCn To Controller +5V 1/8 RPx2 1/4 NEC2505 I/On 1/8 RPx3

Controller I/O OUTCn

Figure A-10 ­ IOM-1964 Digital Output with Internal Pullup Resistor The resistor pack RPx3 limits the amount of current available to source, as well as affecting the low level voltage at the I/O output. The maximum sink current is 2mA regardless of RPx3 or I/OC voltage, determined by the NEC2505 optical isolator IC. The maximum source current is determined by dividing the external power supply voltage by the resistor value of RPx3. The high level voltage at the I/O output is equal to the external supply voltage at I/OC. However, when the output transistor is on and conducting current, the low level output voltage is determined by three factors. The external supply voltage, the resistor pack RPx3 value, and the current sinking limit of the NEC2505 all determine the low level voltage. The sink current available from the NEC2505 is between 0 and 2mA. Therefore, the maximum voltage drop across RPx3 is calculated by multiplying the 2mA maximum current times the resistor value of RPx3. For example, if a 10k ohm resistor pack is used for RPx3, then the maximum voltage drop is 20 volts. The digital output will never drop below the voltage at OUTC, however. Therefore, a 10k ohm resistor pack will result in a low level voltage of .7 to 1.0 volts at the I/O output for an external supply voltage between 4 and 21 VDC. If a supply voltage greater than 21 VDC is used, a higher value resistor pack will be required.

DMC-14x5/6

Appendices i 169


Output Command CBn SBn

Result Vout = GNDiso

Vout = Viso

The resistor pack RPx3 is removed to provide open collector outputs. The same calculations for maximum source current and low level voltage applies as in the above circuit. The maximum sink current is determined by the NEC2505, and is approximately 2mA.
Open Collector To DMC-14XX +5V 1/8 RPx2 1/4 NEC2505 I/On

DMC-14XX I/O OUTCn

Figure A-11 ­ IOM-1964 Digital Output Configured as Open Collector

Electrical Specifications
· I/O points, configurable as inputs or outputs in groups of 8

Digital Inputs · · · Maximum voltage: 28 VDC Minimum input voltage: 4 VDC Maximum input current: 3 mA

High Power Digital Outputs · · · · Maximum external power supply voltage: 28 VDC Minimum external power supply voltage: 4 VDC Maximum source current, per output: 500mA Maximum sink current: sinking circuit inoperative

Standard Digital Outputs · · · Maximum external power supply voltage: 28 VDC Minimum external power supply voltage: 4 VDC Maximum source current: limited by pull up resistor value

170 i Appendices

DMC-14x5/6


·

Maximum sink current: 2mA

Relevant DMC Commands
CO n Configures the 64 bits of extended I/O in 8 banks of 8 bits each. n = n2 + 2*n3 + 4*n4 + 8*n5 + 16*n6 + 32*n7 + 64*n8 + 128*n9 where nx is a 1 or 0, 1 for outputs and 0 for inputs. The x is the bank number m = 8 standard di n = extended I/O o = extended I/O p = extended I/O q = extended I/O gital outputs banks 0 & 1, banks 2 & 3, banks 4 & 5, banks 6 & 7, outputs outputs outputs outputs 17-32 33-48 49-64 65-80

OP m,n,o,p,q

SB n CB n OB n,m TI n _TI n @IN[n]

Sets the output bit to a logic 1, n is the number of the output from 1 to 80. Clears the output bit to a logic 0, n is the number of the output from 1 to 80. Sets the state of an output as 0 or 1, also able to use logical conditions. Returns the state of 8 digital inputs as binary converted to decimal, n is the bank number +2. Operand (internal variable) that holds the same value as that returned by TI n. Function that returns state of individual input bit, n is number of the input from 1 to 80.

J5 80-pin Connector Pin out
Pin 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 Signal I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O GND I/O GND I/O GND I/O Block 8 9 8 9 8 9 8 9 8 9 8 9 8 9 8 9 7 -7 -7 -7 Bit @IN[n], @OUT[n] 72 73 71 74 70 75 69 76 68 77 67 78 66 79 65 80 64 -63 -62 -61 Bit No 7 0 6 1 5 2 4 3 3 4 2 5 1 6 0 7 7 GND 6 GND 5 GND 4

DMC-14x5/6

Appendices i 171


24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68

GND I/O GND I/O GND I/O GND I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O +5V I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O GND I/O GND I/O GND I/O GND I/O GND I/O GND

-7 -7 -7 -7 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 -4 5 4 5 4 5 4 5 4 5 4 5 4 5 4 5 3 -3 -3 3 -3 -3 --

-60 -59 -58 -57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 -40 41 39 42 38 43 37 44 36 45 35 46 34 47 33 48 32 -31 -30 -29 -28 -27 --

GND 3 GND 2 GND 1 GND 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 +5V 7 0 6 1 5 2 4 3 3 4 2 5 1 6 0 7 7 GND 6 GND 5 GND 4 GND 3 GND 2 GND

172 i Appendices

DMC-14x5/6


69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80

I/O GND I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O I/O +5V

3 -3 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 --

26 -25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 --

1 GND 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 +5V

Screw Terminal Listing
Rev A+B boards (orange) and Rev C boards (black) have the pinouts listed below
REV A+B TERMINAL # 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 2 1 4 3 6 5 8 7 10 9 12 11 14 13 16 15 18 17 20 19 22 21 24 REV C TERMINAL # LABEL GND 5V GND 5V I/O80 I/O79 I/O78 I/O77 I/O76 I/O75 I/O74 I/O73 OUTC73-80 I/OC73-80 I/O72 I/O71 I/O70 I/O69 I/O68 I/O67 I/O66 I/O65 OUTC65-72 I/OC65-72 DESCRIPTION Ground 5V DC out Ground 5V DC out I/O bit 80 I/O bit 79 I/O bit 78 I/O bit 77 I/O bit 76 I/O bit 75 I/O bit 74 I/O bit 73 Out common for I/O 73-80 I/O common for I/O 73-80 I/O bit 72 I/O bit 71 I/O bit 70 I/O bit 69 I/O bit 68 I/O bit 67 I/O bit 66 I/O bit 65 Out common for I/O 65-72 I/O common for I/O 65-72 BANK N/A N/A N/A N/A 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6

DMC-14x5/6

Appendices i 173


25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69

23 26 25 28 27 30 29 32 31 34 33 36 35 38 37 40 39 42 41 44 43 46 45 48 47 50 49 52 51 54 53 56 55 58 57 60 59 62 61 64 63 66 65 68 67

I/O64 I/O63 I/O62 I/O61 I/O60 I/O59 I/O58 I/O57 OUTC57-64 I/OC57-64 I/O56 I/O55 I/O54 I/O53 I/O52 I/O51 I/O50 I/O49 OUTC49-56 I/OC49-56 I/O48 I/O47 I/O46 I/O45 I/O44 I/O43 I/O42 I/O41 OUTC41-48 I/OC41-48 I/O40 I/O39 I/O38 I/O37 I/O36 I/O35 I/O34 I/O33 OUTC33-40 I/OC33-40 I/O32 I/O31 I/O30 I/O29 I/O28

I/O bit 64 I/O bit 63 I/O bit 62 I/O bit 61 I/O bit 60 I/O bit 59 I/O bit 58 I/O bit 57 Out common for I/O 57-64 I/O common for I/O 57-64 I/O bit 56 I/O bit 55 I/O bit 54 I/O bit 53 I/O bit 52 I/O bit 51 I/O bit 50 I/O bit 49 Out common for I/O 49-56 I/O common for I/O 49-56 I/O bit 48 I/O bit 47 I/O bit 46 I/O bit 45 I/O bit 44 I/O bit 43 I/O bit 42 I/O bit 41 Out common for I/O 41-48 I/O common for I/O 41-48 I/O bit 40 I/O bit 39 I/O bit 38 I/O bit 37 I/O bit 36 I/O bit 35 I/O bit 34 I/O bit 33 Out common for I/O 33-40 I/O common for I/O 33-40 I/O bit 32 I/O bit 31 I/O bit 30 I/O bit 29 I/O bit 28

5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1

174 i Appendices

DMC-14x5/6


70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103 104

70 69 72 71 74 73 76 75 78 77 80 79 82 81 84 83 86 85 88 87 90 89 92 91 94 93 96 95 98 97 100 99 102 101 104 103

I/O27 I/O26 I/O25 OUTC25-32 I/OC25-32 OUTC25-32 I/OC25-32 PWROUT32 PWROUT31 PWROUT30 PWROUT29 PWROUT28 PWROUT27 PWROUT26 PWROUT25 I/O24 I/O23 I/O22 I/O21 I/O20 I/O19 I/O18 I/O17 OUTC17-24 I/OC17-24 OUTC17-24 I/OC17-24 PWROUT24 PWROUT23 PWROUT22 PWROUT21 PWROUT20 PWROUT19 PWROUT18 PWROUT17 GND

I/O bit 27 I/O bit 26 I/O bit 25 Out common for I/O 25-32 I/O common for I/O 25-32 Out common for I/O 25-32 I/O common for I/O 25-32 Power output 32 Power output 31 Power output 30 Power output 29 Power output 28 Power output 27 Power output 26 Power output 25 I/O bit 24 I/O bit 23 I/O bit 22 I/O bit 21 I/O bit 20 I/O bit 19 I/O bit 18 I/O bit 17 Out common for I/O 17-24 I/O common for I/O 17-24 Out common for I/O 17-24 I/O common for I/O 17-24 Power output 24 Power output 23 Power output 22 Power output 21 Power output 20 Power output 19 Power output 18 Power output 17 Ground

1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0

*Silkscreen on Rev A board is incorrect for these terminals.

DMC-14x5/6

Appendices i 175


CB-50-80 Adapter Board
The CB-50-80 adapter board can be used to convert the (2) 50 Pin Ribbon Cables from a DB-14064 to a CABLE-80. The CABLE-80 is used to connect to the IOM-1964.

Connectors:
JC8 and JC6: 50 Pin Male IDC J9: 80 Pin High Density Connector, AMP PART #3-178238-0
JC8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 J9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 GND 19 GND 21 GND 23 GND 25 GND 27 GND 29 GND 31 GND 32 GND 33 GND 34 JC8 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 J9 GND 35 GND 36 GND 37 GND 38 GND 39 GND +5V GND

176 i Appendices

DMC-14x5/6


JC6 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50

J9 (Continued) 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 GND 59 GND 61 GND 63 GND 65 GND 67 GND 69 GND 71 GND 72 GND 73 GND 74 GND 75 GND 76 GND 77 GND 78 GND 79 GND +5V GND

DMC-14x5/6

Appendices i 177


CB-50-80 Drawing:
CB-50-80 Outline
1/8" 15/16" 1/8"D, 4 places Mounting bracket for attaching inside PC JC6, JC8 - 50 pin shrouded headers w/ center key JC8 - pins 1-50 of J9 JC6 - pins 51-100 of J9

1/8"

CB 50-80 REV A1 GALIL M OTION CONTROL M ADE IN USA J9 JC8 JC6

4 1/2"

J9 - 80 pin connector 3M part # N10280-52E2VC AMP part # 3-178238-0

1/8" 1/2" 1 1/4" 9/16"

Figure A-12 ­ CB-50-80 Outline

178 i Appendices

DMC-14x5/6


CB-50-80 Layout
JC6 (IDC 50 Pin) Pin1 ()
CB 50-80 REV A GALIL MOTION CONTROL MADE IN USA

1/8"D, 4 places J9 - 80 pin connector AMP part # 3-178238-0 (Pin 1)

JC8 (IDC 50 Pin) Pin1 ( )

J9 DET AIL
1 3 4 2 41 43 42

JC6, JC8 - 50 pin shrouded headers w/ center key

JC8

JC6

Figure A-13 ­ CB-50-80 Layout

Coordinated Motion - Mathematical Analysis
The terms of coordinated motion are best explained in terms of the vector motion. The vector velocity, Vs, which is also known as the feed rate, is the vector sum of the velocities along the X and Y axes, Vx and Vy.

Vs = Vx 2 + Vy

2

The vector distance is the integral of Vs, or the total distance traveled along the path. To illustrate this further, suppose that a string was placed along the path in the X-Y plane. The length of that string represents the distance traveled by the vector motion. The vector velocity is specified independently of the path to allow continuous motion. The path is specified as a collection of segments. For the purpose of specifying the path, define a special X-Y coordinate system whose origin is the starting point of the sequence. Each linear segment is specified

DMC-14x5/6

Appendices i 179


by the X-Y coordinate of the final point expressed in units of resolution, and each circular arc is defined by the arc radius, the starting angle, and the angular width of the arc. The zero angle corresponds to the positive direction of the X-axis and the CCW direction of rotation is positive. Angles are expressed in degrees, and the resolution is 1/256th of a degree. For example, the path shown in Fig. A-14 is specified by the instructions: VP CR VP 0,10000 10000, 180, -90 20000, 20000

Y
20000

C

D

10000

B

A
10000
Figure A-14 - X-Y Motion Path

X
20000

The first line describes the straight line vector segment between points A and B. The next segment is a circular arc, which starts at an angle of 180° and traverses -90°. Finally, the third line describes the linear segment between points C and D. Note that the total length of the motion consists of the segments: A -B B-C C-D Linear Circular Linear Total 10000 units

R 2 = 15708 360
10000 35708 counts

In general, the length of each linear segment is

L

k=

Xk 2 + Yk

2

180 i Appendices

DMC-14x5/6


Where Xk and Yk are the changes in X and Y positions along the linear segment. The length of the circular arc is

Lk = R k k 2 360
The total travel distance is given by

D=


k =1

n

L

k

The velocity profile may be specified independently in terms of the vector velocity and acceleration. For example, the velocity profile corresponding to the path of Fig. A-14 may be specified in terms of the vector speed and acceleration. VS VA 100000 2000000

The resulting vector velocity is shown in Fig. A-15.

Velocity
10000

time (s)
T
a

0.05

T

s

0.357

T

a

0.407

Figure A-15 - Vector Velocity Profile

The acceleration time, Ta, is given by

Ta =

VS 100000 = = 0. 05s VA 2000000

The slew time, Ts, is given by

Ts =

D 35708 - Ta = - 0. 05 = 0. 307 s VS 100000
D + T a = 0. 407s VS

The total motion time, Tt, is given by

Tt =

The velocities along the X and Y axes are such that the direction of motion follows the specified path, yet the vector velocity fits the vector speed and acceleration requirements. For example, the velocities along the X and Y axes for the path shown in Fig. A-14 are given in Fig. A-16.

DMC-14x5/6

Appendices i 181


Fig. A-16(a) shows the vector velocity. It also indicates the position point along the path starting at A and ending at D. Between the points A and B, the motion is along the Y axis. Therefore, Vy = Vs and Vx = 0 Between the points B and C, the velocities vary gradually and finally, between the points C and D, the motion is in the X direction.
B C (a)

Vector Velocity

A

D

X Velocity

(b)

Y Velocity
(c)

time
Figure A-16 - Vector and Axes Velocities

182 i Appendices

DMC-14x5/6


List of Other Publications
"Step by Step Design of Motion Control Systems" by Dr. Jacob Tal "Motion Control Applications" by Dr. Jacob Tal "Motion Control by Microprocessors" by Dr. Jacob Tal

Training Seminars
Galil, a leader in motion control with over 250,000 controllers working worldwide, has a proud reputation for anticipating and setting the trends in motion control. Galil understands your need to keep abreast with these trends in order to remain resourceful and competitive. Through a series of seminars and workshops held over the past 15 years, Galil has actively shared their market insights in a no-nonsense way for a world of engineers on the move. In fact, over 10,000 engineers have attended Galil seminars. The tradition continues with three different seminar, each designed for your particular skill set-from beginner to the most advanced. MOTION CONTROL MADE EASY WHO SHOULD ATTEND Those who need a basic introduction or refresher on how to successfully implement servo motion control systems. TIME: 4 hours (8:30 am-12:30 pm) ADVANCED MOTION CONTROL WHO SHOULD ATTEND Those who consider themselves a "servo specialist" and require an in-depth knowledge of motion control systems to ensure outstanding controller performance. Also, prior completion of "Motion Control Made Easy" or equivalent is required. Analysis and design tools as well as several design examples will be provided. TIME: 8 hours (8:00 am-5:00 pm) PRODUCT WORKSHOP WHO SHOULD ATTEND Current users of Galil motion controllers. Conducted at Galil's headquarters in Rocklin, CA, students will gain detailed understanding about connecting systems elements, system tuning and motion programming. This is a "hands-on" seminar and students can test their application on actual hardware and review it with Galil specialists. TIME: Two days (8:30 am-5:00 pm)

DMC-14x5/6

Appendices i 183


Contacting Us
Galil Motion Control 270 Technology Way Rocklin, California 95765 Phone: 916-626-0101 Fax: 916-626-0102 Internet address: support@galilmc.com URL: www.galilmc.com FTP: galilmc.com

184 i Appendices

DMC-14x5/6


WARRANTY
All products manufactured by Galil Motion Control are warranted against defects in materials and workmanship. The warranty period for controller boards is 1 year. The warranty period for all other products is 180 days. In the event of any defects in materials or workmanship, Galil Motion Control will, at its sole option, repair or replace the defective product covered by this warranty without charge. To obtain warranty service, the defective product must be returned within 30 days of the expiration of the applicable warranty period to Galil Motion Control, properly packaged and with transportation and insurance prepaid. We will reship at our expense only to destinations in the United States. Any defect in materials or workmanship determined by Galil Motion Control to be attributable to customer alteration, modification, negligence or misuse is not covered by this warranty. EXCEPT AS SET FORTH ABOVE, GALIL MOTION CONTROL WILL MAKE NO WARRANTIES EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, WITH RESPECT TO SUCH PRODUCTS, AND SHALL NOT BE LIABLE OR RESPONSIBLE FOR ANY INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES. COPYRIGHT (3-97) The software code contained in this Galil product is protected by copyright and must not be reproduced or disassembled in any form without prior written consent of Galil Motion Control, Inc.

DMC-14x5/6

Appendices i 185


Index

A
Abort 33­34, 60, 66, 131, 133, 151 Off-On-Error 19, 34, 35, 131, 133 Stop Motion 60, 66, 108, 134 Absolute Position 56­57, 100, 104 Absolute Value 71, 104, 112, 132 Acceleration 101­2, 118, 123, 181 Address 115­17, 184 Jumpers 39 Ampflier Gain 4 Amplifier AMP-1460 8 Amplifier Enable 35, 131 Amplifier Gain 141, 145, 147 Amplifiers 8, 156 Connections 157 Analog Input 115 Analysis SDK 27 WSDK 152 Arithmetic Functions 91, 103, 111, 113, 123 Array 3, 56, 65, 77­80, 91, 96, 103, 111, 114­22, 123, 152 Automatic Subroutine 106, 107 CMDERR 107, 109 LIMSWI 33, 106­7, 132­34 MCTIME 99, 107, 108 POSERR 106­8, 132­33 Auxiliary Encoder 80­85 Dual Encoder 53, 117

Bit-Wise 103, 111 Burn EEPROM 3

C
Capture Data Record 56, 76, 80, 115, 117 Circle 127­28 Circular Interpolation 65­67, 116, 127 Clear Sequence 60, 62, 66, 67 Clock 114 CMDERR 107, 109 Code 107, 114, 117­19, 126­27 Command Syntax 49­50 Command Summary 54, 57, 59, 62, 67, 114, 116 Commanded Position 69­70, 109, 117, 137­39 Communication 3, 8 Baud Rate 15, 39 Handshake 39 Serial Ports 12 Compensation Backlash 56 Conditional jump 91, 98, 101­4, 125 Configuring Encoders 84 Contour Mode 55­56, 75­80 Control Filter Damping 27, 136, 140 Gain 119 Integrator 27, 140, 144­45 Proportional Gain 27, 140 Coordinated Motion 50, 55, 65­67 Circular 65­67, 116, 127 Contour Mode 55­56, 75­80 Ecam 71­72, 74 Electronic Cam 55­56, 70, 73 Electronic Gearing 55­56, 68­70 Gearing 55­56, 68­70 Linear Interpolation 55, 60­62, 64, 75

B
Backlash 56 Backlash Compensation 83 Dual Loop 56, 80­85 Baud Rate 15, 39 Begin Motion 93­96, 100­101, 107­8, 117­19, 123, 125 Binary 49, 52

186 i Index

DMC-14x5/6


Cosine 56, 111­12, 115 Cycle Time Clock 114

Off-On-Error 19, 34, 35, 131, 133 Example Wire Cutter 126 Execute Program 31

D
DAC 140, 144­45, 147 Damping 27, 136, 140 Data Capture 116­17 Data Record 44, 45, 46, 47 Debugging 96 Deceleration 118 Differential Encoder 19, 21, 136 Digital Filter 49, 144­45, 147­49 Gain 8 Stability 83 Digital Input 33, 35, 112, 124 Digital Output 112, 123 Dip Switch Address 115­17, 184 Download 49, 91, 116 Dual Encoder 53, 83, 84, 117 Backlash 56 Dual Loop 56, 80­85 Dual Loop 56, 80­85, 84 Backlash 56

F
Feedrate 62, 66, 67, 101, 127­28 FIFO 48 Filter Parameter Damping 27, 136, 140 Gain 119 Integrator 27, 140, 144­45 PID 22, 140, 144, 149 Proportional Gain 27, 140 Stability 135­36, 140, 146 Find Edge 34, 46 Formatting 119, 120­22 Variable 32 Frequency 5, 86, 146­48 Function 34, 49, 60, 77­78, 91, 95­99, 101, 103, 107, 110­15, 119­20 Functions Arithmetic 91, 103, 111, 113, 123

G
Gain 8, 119 Proportional 27, 140 Gear Ratio 69 Gearing 55­56, 68­70, 152

E
Ecam 71­72, 74 Electronic Cam 55­56, 70, 73 Echo 46, 47 Edit Mode 97, 107 Editor 30, 91­92 EEPROM 3 Electronic Cam 55­56, 70, 73 Electronic Gearing 55­56, 68­70 Ellipse Scale 67 Enable Amplifer Enable 35, 131 Encoder Auxiliary Encoder 80­85 Differential 19, 21, 136 Dual Encoder 53, 117 Index Pulse 19, 34 Quadrature 5, 123, 126, 132, 143 Encoders 84 Auxiliary Encoders 156 Dual Loop 84 Index 156 Quadrature 156 Error Handling 93 Error Code 107, 114, 117­19, 126­27 Error Handling 33, 106­7, 132­34 Error Limit 19, 20, 35, 107, 131­33

H
Halt 61, 95­99, 101­2, 124 Abort 33­34, 60, 66, 131, 133, 151 Off-On-Error 19, 34, 35, 131, 133 Stop Motion 60, 66, 108, 134 Hardware 33, 123, 131 Address 115­17, 184 Amplifier Enable 35, 131 Offset Adjustment 135 Output of Data 119 TTL 5, 33, 35, 131 Home Input 34, 114 Home Inputs 87 Homing 34 Find Edge 34

I
I/O Amplifier Enable 35, 131 Digital Input 33, 35, 112, 124 Digital Output 112, 123 Home Input 34, 114

DMC-14x5/6

Index i 187


Output of Data 119 TTL 5, 33, 35, 131 ICB-1460 8 ICM-1100 18, 19, 35 Independent Motion Jog 59, 69, 75, 100­101, 107­9, 133 Index 156 Index Pulse 19, 34 ININT 107­8 Input Interrupt 101, 107­8, 125 ININT 107­8 Input of Data 118 Inputs Analog 115 Index 156 Interconnect Module 157 Installation 9, 135 Integrator 27, 140, 144­45 Interconnect Board 8 Interconnect Module 157 ICM-1100 19, 35 Interface Terminal 49 Internal Variable 103, 113, 114 Interrogation 27, 53­54, 62, 68, 119, 120, 153 Interrupt 93, 101, 106­8, 125, 157 Invert 136

M
Masking Bit-Wise 103, 111 Math Function Absolute Value 71, 104, 112, 132 Bit-Wise 103, 111 Cosine 56, 111­12, 115 Logical Operator 103 Sine 56, 74, 112 Mathematical Expression 103, 110, 112 MCTIME 99, 107, 108 Memory 30, 49, 79, 91, 96, 103, 107, 114, 116 Array 3, 56, 65, 77­80, 91, 96, 103, 111, 114­22, 123, 152 Download 49, 91, 116 Message 47, 65, 96, 107­8, 111, 117­19, 125, 133­34 Modelling 137, 140­41, 144 Motion Complete MCTIME 99, 107, 108 Motion Smoothing 56, 85, 86 S-Curve 85 Motor Command 21­22, 144 Moving Acceleration 101­2, 118, 123, 181 Begin Motion 93­96, 100­101, 107­8, 117­19, 123, 125 Circular 65­67, 116, 127 Home Inputs 87 Slew Speed 157 Multitasking 95 Halt 61, 95­99, 101­2, 124

J
Jog 59, 69, 75, 100­101, 107­9, 133 Jumpers 39

K
Keyword 103, 111, 113, 114­15 TIME 114­15

O
OE Off-On-Error 131, 133 Off-On-Error 19, 34, 35, 46, 131, 133 Offset Adjustment 135 Operand Internal Variable 103, 113, 114 Operators Bit-Wise 103, 111 Optoisolation Home Input 34, 114 Output Amplifier Enable 35, 131 ICM-1100 19, 35 Motor Command 21­22, 144 Output of Data 119 Outputs Interconnect Module 157

L
Label 65, 73­74, 80, 91­97, 100­108, 118, 120, 123­ 25, 128, 133 LIMSWI 132­34 POSERR 132­33 Special Label 93, 133 Latch 53 Data Capture 116­17 Record 56, 76, 80, 115, 117 Teach 80 Limit Torque Limit 21 Limit Switch 33­34, 107, 114, 132­34, 136 LIMSWI 33, 106­7, 132­34 Linear Interpolation 55, 60­62, 64, 75 Clear Sequence 60, 62, 66, 67 Logical Operator 103

P
PID 22, 140, 144, 149

188 i Index

DMC-14x5/6


Play Back 56, 117 POSERR 106­8, 132­33 Position Error 107­8, 114, 116­17 Position Capture 90 Latch 53 Teach 80 Position Error 19, 35, 107­8, 114, 116­17, 131­33, 136, 139 POSERR 106­8 Position Latch 90, 157 Position Limit 132 Program Flow 92, 98 Interrupt 101, 106­8, 125 Stack 106, 109, 125 Programmable 113­14, 123, 132 EEPROM 3 Programming Halt 61, 95­99, 101­2, 124 Proportional Gain 27, 140 Protection Error Limit 19, 20, 35, 107, 131­33 Torque Limit 21 PWM 4, 155­56, 155­56, 155­56, 155­56

Q
Quadrature 5, 123, 126, 132, 143, 156 Quit Abort 33­34, 60, 66, 131, 133, 151 Stop Motion 60, 66, 108, 134

SDK 27 Terminal 49 WSDK 152 Special Label 93, 133 Specification 60­62, 67 Stability 83, 135­36, 140, 146 Stack 106, 109, 125 Zero Stack 109, 125 Status 49, 53, 62, 96­98, 114, 117 Interrogation 27, 53­54, 62, 68, 119, 120 Stop Code 53, 117, 136 Tell Code 53 Step Motor 86 KS, Smoothing 56, 61, 62, 66, 67, 85­86 Step Motors 8­11, 156 PWM 155­56, 155­56, 155­56, 155­56 Stop Abort 33­34, 60, 66, 131, 133, 151 Stop Code 53, 107, 114, 117­19, 117, 126­27, 136 Stop Motion 60, 66, 108, 134 Stop Motion or Program 157 Subroutine 33, 65, 93, 102­8, 125, 132­33, 157 Automatic Subroutine 106, 107 Synchronization 5, 70 Syntax 49­50

T
Tangent 56 Teach 80 Data Capture 116­17 Latch 53 Play-Back 56, 117 Record 56, 76, 80, 115, 117 Tell Code 53 Tell Error 53 Position Error 107­8, 114, 116­17 Tell Position 47, 53 Tell Torque 53 Terminal 33, 49, 114 Theory 28, 137 Damping 27, 136, 140 Digital Filter 49, 144­45, 147­49 Modelling 137, 140­41, 144 PID 22, 140, 144, 149 Stability 135­36, 140, 146 Time Clock 114 TIME 114­15 Time Interval 75­76, 80, 116 Timeout 13, 99, 107, 108 MCTIME 99, 107, 108 Torque Limit 21 Trigger 91, 98, 100­102, 139 Trippoint 57, 61­62, 67, 76, 100, 105, 106, 153 Trippoints 31

R
Record 56, 76, 80, 115, 117 Latch 53 Teach 80 Register 114 Reset 33, 36, 47, 102, 131, 133, 153, 154, 155

S
Scaling Ellipse Scale 67 S-Curve 85 Motion Smoothing 56, 85, 86 SDK 27 Selecting Address 115­17, 184 Serial Port 12 Servo Design Kit 8 SDK 27 Sine 56, 74, 112 Single-Ended 5, 19, 21 Slew 56, 99, 101, 126 Slew Speed 157 Smoothing 56, 61, 62, 66, 67, 85­86 Software

DMC-14x5/6

Index i 189


Troubleshooting 135 TTL 5, 33, 35, 131 Tuning SDK 27 Stability 135­36, 140, 146 WSDK 152

U
Upload 152 User Unit 123

Vector Mode Circle 127­28 Circular Interpolation 65­67, 116, 127 Clear Sequence 60, 62, 66, 67 Ellipse Scale 67 Feedrate 62, 66, 67, 101, 127­28 Tangent 56 Vector Speed 60­66, 67, 101, 128

W
Wire Cutter 126 WSDK 152

V
Variable 32 Internal 103, 113, 114 Vector Acceleration 62­63, 67, 128 Vector Deceleration 62­63, 67

Z
Zero Stack 109, 125

190 i Index

DMC-14x5/6